Microsoft Printer PRO 1106EX User Manual

Operating Instructions  
General Settings Guide  
Connecting the Machine  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
System Settings  
Tray Paper Settings  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Printer Features  
Scanner Features  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Other User Tools  
Appendix  
Read this manual carefully before you use this machine and keep it handy for future reference. For safe and correct use, be sure to read the  
Safety Information in "About This Machine" before using the machine.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manuals for This Machine  
Refer to the manuals that are relevant to what you want to do with the machine.  
About This Machine  
Be sure to read the Safety Information in this manual before using the ma-  
chine.  
This manual provides an introduction to the functions of the machine. It also  
explains the control panel, preparation procedures for using the machine,  
how to enter text, and how to install the CD-ROMs provided.  
General Settings Guide  
Explains User Tools settings, and Address Book procedures such as register-  
ing e-mail addresses, and user codes. Also refer to this manual for explana-  
tions on how to connect the machine.  
Troubleshooting  
Provides a guide to solving common problems, and explains how to replace  
paper, toner, staples, and other consumables.  
Security Reference  
This manual is for administrators of the machine. It explains security func-  
tions that the administrators can use to protect data from being tampered, or  
prevent the machine from unauthorized use.  
Also refer to this manual for the procedures for registering administrators, as  
well as setting user and administrator authentication.  
Copy / Document Server Reference  
Explains Copier and Document Server functions and operations. Also refer to  
this manual for explanations on how to place originals.  
Printer Reference  
Explains Printer functions and operations.  
Scanner Reference  
Explains Scanner functions and operations.  
Network Guide  
Explains how to configure and operate the machine in a network environ-  
ment, and use the software provided.  
This manual covers all models, and includes descriptions of functions and  
settings that might not be available on this machine. Images, illustrations, and  
information about operating systems that are supported might also differ  
slightly from those of this machine.  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Other manuals  
• PostScript3 Supplement  
• UNIX Supplement  
• Manuals for DeskTopBinder Lite  
• DeskTopBinder Lite Setup Guide  
• DeskTopBinder Introduction Guide  
• Auto Document Link Guide  
Note  
Manuals provided are specific to machine types. For details, refer to the ap-  
pendix in About This Machine.  
Adobe Acrobat Reader/Adobe Reader must be installed in order to view the  
manuals as PDF files.  
For "UNIX Supplement", please visit our Web site or consult an authorized  
dealer.  
"PostScript3 Supplement" and "UNIX Supplement" include descriptions of  
functions and settings that might not be available on this machine.  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quitting User Tools ....................................................................................................4  
About Menu Protect ...................................................................................................5  
Connecting with the USB Interface ............................................................................9  
Settings Required to Use the Printer........................................................................15  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder Function..................................................22  
Settings Required to Use Network TWAIN Scanner................................................28  
Using Utilities to Make Settings................................................................................33  
Network....................................................................................................................52  
IEEE 1394................................................................................................................57  
Timer Settings..........................................................................................................84  
Administrator Tools ..................................................................................................86  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings ..............................................................................91  
Tray Paper Setting on Main and Sub-machines..............................................111  
Preset Stamp .........................................................................................................130  
Date Stamp ............................................................................................................135  
Reproduction Ratio ................................................................................................148  
Input/Output ...........................................................................................................155  
PS Menu..............................................................................................................170  
Scan Settings .....................................................................................................175  
Send Settings.....................................................................................................177  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending e-mail by Quick Dial.................................................................................182  
Registering Names.................................................................................................184  
Changing a User Code...........................................................................................189  
Displaying the Counter for Each User....................................................................191  
Registering an E-mail Destination..........................................................................196  
Registering a Group...............................................................................................218  
Adding a Groupe to Another Group .......................................................................221  
Removing a Name from a Group ...........................................................................223  
LDAP Authentication..............................................................................................233  
Displaying the Total Counter..................................................................................238  
Method of Counting................................................................................................239  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Booklet Finisher BK5000........................................................................................261  
Punch Unit PU5000................................................................................................263  
LCIT RT5000..........................................................................................................264  
expat ......................................................................................................................267  
Sablotron................................................................................................................270  
SASL......................................................................................................................271  
Open LDAP............................................................................................................281  
INDEX....................................................................................................... 283  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Read This Manual  
Symbols  
This manual uses the following symbols:  
Indicates important safety notes.  
Ignoring these notes could result in serious injury or death. Be sure to read these  
notes. They can be found in the "Safety Information" section of About This Ma-  
chine.  
Indicates important safety notes.  
Ignoring these notes could result in moderate or minor injury, or damage to the  
machine or to property. Be sure to read these notes. They can be found in the  
"Safety Information" section of About This Machine.  
Indicates points to pay attention to when using the machine, and explanations  
of likely causes of paper misfeeds, damage to originals, or loss of data. Be sure  
to read these explanations.  
Indicates supplementary explanations of the machine’s functions, and instruc-  
tions on resolving user errors.  
This symbol is located at the end of sections. It indicates where you can find fur-  
ther relevant information.  
[ ]  
Indicates the names of keys that appear on the machine’s display panel.  
{ }  
Indicates the names of keys on the machine’s control panel.  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Display  
The display panel shows machine status, error messages, and function menus.  
The function items displayed serve as selector keys. You can select or specify an  
item by lightly pressing them.  
When you select or specify an item on the display panel, it is highlighted like  
. Keys appearing as  
cannot be used.  
Important  
A force or impact of more than 30 N (about 3 kgf) will damage the display  
panel.  
To display the following screen, press the {User Tools} key to display the User  
Tools menu, and then press [System Settings].  
Using the System Settings menu screen as an example, this section explains how  
to use the machine’s control panel.  
APD018S  
1. The menu tabs for various settings appear. To display the setting you want  
to specify or change, press the appropriate menu tab.  
2. A list of settings appears. To display the setting you want to specify or  
change, select the appropriate entry in the list.  
3. Press this to close the User Tools menu.  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Accessing User Tools (System Settings)  
This section is for Administrators in charge of this machine.  
User Tools allow you to change or set defaults.  
Note  
Operations for system settings differ from normal operations. Always quit  
User Tools when you have finished.  
Any changes you make with User Tools remain in effect even if the main  
power switch or operation switch is turned off, or the {Energy Saver} or {Clear  
Reference  
p.4 “Quitting User Tools”  
Changing Default Settings  
This section describes how to change the settings of User Tools.  
Important  
If the Administrator Authentications specified, contact your administrator.  
A Press the {User Tools} key.  
APD014S  
B Select the menu.  
To change the System Settings, Press [System Settings].  
To change the Copier/Document Server Features, Press [Copier/Document  
Server Features].  
To change the Printer Features, Press [Printer Features].  
To change the Scanner Features, Press [Scanner Features].  
To adjust color registration or gradation, press [Maintenance].  
To find out who to contact for maintenance and where to order consumables,  
press [Inquiry].  
C Select the menu tab.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
D Change settings by following instructions on the display, and then press  
[OK].  
Note  
To cancel changes made to settings and return to the initial display, press  
the {User Tools} key.  
p.173 “Scanner Features”  
p.235 “Other User Tools”  
Quitting User Tools  
This section describes how to end User Tools.  
A Press the {User Tools} key.  
APD014S  
Note  
You can also quit User Tools by pressing [Exit].  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Displaying Counter  
This section describes how to display Counter.  
A Press the {Counter} key.  
APD016S  
Note  
You can quit displaying Counter by pressing the {Counter} key again.  
About Menu Protect  
Using Menu Protect, you can limit the settings available to users other than the  
administrator. In the following User Tools menus, you can specify Menu Protect  
for each setting.  
• Copier/Document Server Features  
• Printer Features  
• Scanner Features  
For details about menu protect, contact your administrator.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Connecting the Machine  
Connect the machine to the network to configure network environment.  
Connecting to the Interfaces  
This section explains how to check the machine’s interface, connect the machine  
according to the network environment, and specify the network settings.  
1. IEEE 1394 ports (optional)  
5. Wireless LAN port (optional)  
Ports for connecting the IEEE 1394 inter-  
face cable  
Port for using the wireless LAN  
Note  
2. 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX port  
Port for connecting the 10BASE-T or  
100BASE-TX cable  
Port for connecting the 1000BASE-T,  
100BASE-TX or 10BASE-T cable when  
the Gigabit Ethernet (Optional) is in-  
stalled  
You cannnot install two or more of the  
options below: IEEE 1394 interface  
board, IEEE 1284 interface board,  
IEEE 802.11b wireless LAN  
3. USB2.0 port  
Port for connecting the USB2.0 interface  
cable  
4. IEEE 1284 port (optional)  
Port for connecting the IEEE 1284 inter-  
face cable  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting the Machine  
Connecting to the Ethernet Interface  
Connect 10BASE-T or 100BASE-TX cable to the Ethernet interface.  
Important  
1
If the main power switch is turned "On", turn it "Off".  
A Make sure the main power switch on the machine is "Off".  
B Connect the Ethernet interface cable to the 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX port.  
C Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable to a network connection device  
such as a hub.  
D Turn the main power switch of the machine on.  
AME005S  
A Indicator (green)  
Remains green when the machine is properly connected to the network.  
B Indicator (yellow)  
Turns yellow when 100 BASE-TX is operating. Turns off when 10 BASE-T  
is operating.  
Note  
For details about installing the printer driver, see "Preparing the Machine"  
Printer Reference  
Reference  
"Turning On the Power" About This Machine  
"Preparing the Machine" Printer Reference  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Interfaces  
Connecting with the USB Interface  
Make the connection with the USB 2.0 interface.  
A Connect the USB 2.0 interface cable to the USB2.0 port.  
1
B Connect the other end to the USB port on the host computer.  
Note  
Purchase a USB cable separately according to a personal computer in use.  
The USB 2.0 interface board is supported by Windows Me / 2000 / XP,  
Windows Server 2003, Mac OS X v10.3.3 or higher.  
• For Windows Me:  
Make sure to install “USB Printing Support". If USB 2.0 is used with  
Windows Me, only a speed equal to that of USB 1.1 is possible.  
For details about installing the printer driver, see "Preparing the Machine"  
Printer Reference  
Reference  
"Preparing the Machine" Printer Reference  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting the Machine  
Connecting to the IEEE 1394 Interface  
Connect the IEEE 1394 interface cable to the IEEE 1394 interface board (optional).  
A Connect the IEEE 1394 interface cable to the IEEE 1394 port.  
1
B For IEEE 1394 (SCSI print) connection, plug the other end of the cable into  
the interface connector on the host computer.  
Make sure about the shape of the connector to the computer. Fasten the con-  
nector securely to the computer.  
Note  
Use the interface cable supplied with the IEEE 1394 interface board (op-  
tional).  
Make sure the interface cable is not looped.  
Two interface ports are available for connecting the IEEE 1394 interface ca-  
ble. Either is suitable.  
For details about installing the printer driver, see "Preparing the Machine"  
Printer Reference  
Reference  
"Turning On the Power" About this machine  
"Preparing the Machine" Printer Reference  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting to the Interfaces  
Connecting to the IEEE 1284 Interface  
Connect the IEEE 1284 interface cable to the IEEE 1284 interface board (optional).  
A Make sure the main power switch on the machine is "Off".  
1
If the main power switch is turned "On", turn it "Off".  
B Turn off the main power switch of the host computer  
C Connect the IEEE 1284 interface cable to the IEEE 1284 port.  
To make the connection, use the conversion connector (1) supplied with the  
optional IEEE 1284 interface board.  
D Plug the other end of the cable into the interface connector on the host com-  
puter.  
Make sure about the shape of the connector to the computer. Fasten the con-  
nector securely to the computer.  
E Turn the main power switch of the machine "On".  
F Turn on the host computer.  
When using Windows 95/98/Me/2000/XP and Windows Server 2003, a  
printer driver installation screen might appear when the computer is turned  
on. If this happens, click [Cancel] on the screen.  
Note  
Don't connect the cable in loop state.  
For details about installing the printer driver, see "Preparing the Machine"  
Printer Reference  
Reference  
"Turning On the Power" About this machine  
"Preparing the Machine" Printer Reference  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting the Machine  
Connecting to the IEEE 802.11b (Wireless LAN) Interface  
Connecting to the IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) interface.  
Note  
1
Check the setting of IPv4 address and subnet mask of this machine.  
For how to set IPv4 address and subnet mask from the control panel of the  
machine, see "Interface Settings."  
Reference  
p.52 “Network”  
Setup Procedure  
Setup IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) according to the following flow:  
AME006S  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting to the Interfaces  
Note  
Select [802.11 Ad-hoc] mode when connecting Windows XP as a wireless LAN  
client using Windows XP standard driver or utilities, or when not using the  
infrastructure mode.  
1
For details about how to make settings of wireless LAN from the control pan-  
el on the machine, see "IEEE 802.11b".  
For details about how to make settings of wireless LAN from other than the  
control panel on the machine, see "Using Utilities to Make Settings".  
p.59 “IEEE 802.11b”  
p.33 “Using Utilities to Make Settings”  
Checking the Connection  
Check the wireless LAN connection.  
Make sure the LED of the IEEE 802.11b interface unit is lit.  
When using in infrastructure mode  
1
2
ZGDH600J  
1. If [LAN Type] on the [Interface Settings] / [Network] screen is not set to [IEEE  
802.11b], it does not light, even if the main power is on.  
2. If it is connected properly to the network, the LED is green when in infra-  
structure mode. If the LED is blinking, the machine is searching for devices.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
When using in ad-hoc mode / 802.11 ad-hoc mode  
1
1
2
ZGDH600J  
1. If the IEEE 802.11b interface unit is working, it is lit in orange.  
2. If it is connected properly to the network, the LED is green when in ad-hoc  
mode or 802.11 ad-hoc mode. If the LED is blinking, the machine is searching  
for devices. The LED will light after a few seconds.  
Print the configuration page to verify settings.  
Note  
Reference  
p.158 “Printing the configuration page”  
Checking the Signal  
When using in infrastructure mode, you can check the machine's radio wave sta-  
tus using the control panel.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Interface Settings].  
C Press [IEEE 802.11b].  
D Press [Wireless LAN Signal].  
The machine's radio wave status appears.  
E After checking radio wave status, press [Exit].  
F Press the {User Tools} key to return to the User Tools menu.  
Note  
To check the radio wave status, press [IEEE 802.11b] under [LAN Type] on the  
[Network] screen.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
Network Settings  
This section describes the network settings you can change with User Tools (Sys-  
tem Settings). Make settings according to functions you want to use and the in-  
terface to be connected.  
1
Important  
These settings should be made by the systems administrator, or after consult-  
ing with the systems administrator.  
Settings Required to Use the Printer  
This section lists the settings required for using the printer function.  
Ethernet  
This section lists the settings required for using the printer function with an Eth-  
ernet connection.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv6 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv6 Gateway Address  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfigu-  
ration  
As required  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network NCP Delivery Protocol  
interface settings/Network NW Frame Type  
interface settings/Network SMB Computer Name  
interface settings/Network SMB Work Group  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Connecting the Machine  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
interface settings/Network Machine Name  
As required  
Note  
1
IPv6 can be used only for the printer function.  
In [Effective Protocol], check that the protocol you want to use is set to [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN board is installed. If  
Ethernet and IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) are both connected, the selected in-  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for using Printer with IEEE 1394 inter-  
face cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
Note  
[IEEE 1394]appears when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for using Printer with IEEE 802.11b  
(wireless LAN).  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv6 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv6 Gateway Address  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfigu-  
ration  
As required  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network NCP Delivery Protocol  
interface settings/Network NW Frame Type  
interface settings/Network SMB Computer Name  
interface settings/Network SMB Work Group  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
interface settings/Network Machine Name  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Security Method  
Transmission Speed  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[IEEE 802.11b] and [LAN Type] are displayed when optional wireless LAN inter-  
face board is installed. If both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are  
connected, the selected interface takes precedence.  
1
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
Settings Required to Use E-mail Function  
This section describes necessary set items for sending e-mail.  
Ethernet  
This section describes necessary set items for sending e-mail with Ethernet cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
SMTP Server  
SMTP Authentication  
POP before SMTP  
Reception Protocol  
POP3/IMAP4 Settings  
Administrator's E-mail Address  
E-mail Communication Port  
Program/Change/  
Delete E-mail Message  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Settings  
Heading  
File Transfer  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
As required  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
File Transfer  
As required  
1
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. If both ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected, the  
selected interface takes precedence.  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], also make setting for[Reception Proto-  
col] and [POP3/IMAP4 Settings].  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], check [POP3] port number in [E-mail  
Communication Port].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for sending e-mail with IEEE 1394 in-  
terface cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
Mandatory  
As required  
Mandatory  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
SMTP Server  
SMTP Authentication  
POP before SMTP  
Reception Protocol  
POP3/IMAP4 Settings  
Administrator's E-mail Address  
E-mail Communication Port  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Program/Change/  
Setting Requirements  
File Transfer  
As required  
Delete E-mail Message  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
As required  
As required  
1
Note  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], also make setting for [Reception Proto-  
col] and [POP3/IMAP4 Settings].  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], check [POP3] port number in [E-mail  
Communication Port].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for sending e-mail with IEEE 802.11b  
(wireless LAN).  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Security Method  
Setting Requirements  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Transmission Speed  
As required  
1
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
SMTP Server  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
SMTP Authentication  
POP before SMTP  
Reception Protocol  
POP3/IMAP4 Settings  
Administrator's E-mail Address  
E-mail Communication Port  
Program/Change/  
Delete E-mail Message  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
As required  
As required  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. If both ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected, the  
selected interface takes precedence.  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], also make setting for [Reception Proto-  
col] and [POP3/IMAP4 Settings].  
When setting [POP before SMTP] to [On], check [POP3] port number in [E-mail  
Communication Port].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Machine  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder Function  
This section describes necessary set items for sending file.  
1
Ethernet  
This section describes necessary set items for sending file with ethernet cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. If both ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected, the  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Network Settings  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for sending file with IEEE 1394 inter-  
face cable.  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
Mandatory  
As required  
Mandatory  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
As required  
As required  
Note  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for sending file with IEEE 802.11b  
(wireless LAN).  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
Mandatory  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings  
/IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Security Method  
Transmission Speed  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
As required  
As required  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[IEEE 802.11b] and [LAN Type] are displayed when optional wireless LAN inter-  
face board is installed. If both ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are  
connected, the selected interface takes precedence.  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
Settings Required to Use the Network Delivery Scanner  
This section describes necessary set items for delivering data to network.  
1
Ethernet  
This section describes necessary set items for delivering data to network with  
ethernet cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Delivery Option  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. When both ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected,  
the selected interface takes precedence.  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting the Machine  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for delivering data to network with  
IEEE 1394 interface cable.  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Delivery Option  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
Note  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for delivering data to network with  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN).  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Security Method  
Transmission Speed  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
File Transfer  
Delivery Option  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Number of Scanner Resends  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[IEEE 802.11b] and [LAN Type] are displayed when optional wireless LAN inter-  
face board is installed. When both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b)  
are connected, the selected interface takes precedence.  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
Settings Required to Use Network TWAIN Scanner  
This section describes necessary set items for using TWAIN Scanner under the  
network environment.  
1
Ethernet  
This section describes necessary set items for using network TWAIN Scanner  
with Ethernet cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. When both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected,  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Network Settings  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for using network TWAIN Scanner  
with IEEE 1394 interface cable.  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
Note  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Machine  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for using network TWAIN Scanner  
with IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN).  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Security Method  
Transmission Speed  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[IEEE 802.11b] and [LAN Type] are displayed when optional wireless LAN inter-  
face board is installed. When both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b)  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Network Settings  
Settings Required to Use Document Server  
This section describes necessary set items for using Document Server function  
under the network environment.  
1
Ethernet  
This section describes necessary set items for using Document Server function  
with Ethernet cable.  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network Ethernet Speed  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[LAN Type] is displayed when optional wireless LAN interface board is in-  
stalled. When both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b) are connected,  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting the Machine  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394)  
This section describes necessary set items for using Document Server function  
with IEEE 1394 interface cable.  
1
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 Address  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Host Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 Domain Name  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 WINS Configuration  
interface settings/IEEE 1394 IPv4 over 1394  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
As required  
As required  
Mandatory  
Note  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when optional IEEE 1394 interface board is installed.  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN)  
This section describes necessary set items for using Document Server function  
with IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN).  
For details about specifying the settings, see "Interface Settings" and "File Transfer".  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
Mandatory  
interface settings/Network Machine IPv4 Address  
interface settings/Network IPv4 Gateway Address  
interface settings/Network DNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network DDNS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Domain Name  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/Network WINS Configuration  
interface settings/Network Effective Protocol  
interface settings/Network LAN Type  
As required  
Mandatory  
As required/Mandatory  
As required  
interface settings/Network Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Settings  
Heading  
Setting Item  
Setting Requirements  
As required  
interface settings/Network Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
interface settings/Network Host Name  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Communication Mode  
Mandatory  
1
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
SSID Setting  
As required  
As required  
As required  
As required  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Channel  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Security Method  
Transmission Speed  
interface settings/  
IEEE 802.11b  
Note  
As to [Effective Protocol], check if the protocol to use is set as [Active].  
[IEEE 802.11b] and [LAN Type] are displayed when optional wireless LAN inter-  
face board is installed. When both Ethernet and wireless LAN (IEEE 802.11b)  
p.52 “Interface Settings”  
p.62 “File Transfer”  
Using Utilities to Make Settings  
The network settings can be specified not only on the machine’s control panel  
but also using utilities such as Web Image Monitor, SmartDeviceMonitor for Ad-  
min, and telnet.  
Note  
For details about using Web Image Monitor, see "Using Web Image Monitor",  
Network Guide.  
For details about using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, see "Using SmartDe-  
viceMonitor for Admin", Network Guide.  
For Details about using telnet, see "Remote Maintenance", Network Guide.  
Reference  
"Using Web Image Monitor" Network Guide  
"Using SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin" Network Guide  
"Remote Maintenance by telnet" Network Guide  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting the Machine  
Interface Settings  
Change set values of [Interface Settings] in [System Settings] of this machine by us-  
ing Web Image Monitor, SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, and telnet.  
1
[Network][Machine IPv4 Address][Auto-Obtain (DHCP)]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Machine IPv4 Address][Specify][IPv4 Address]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Machine IPv4 Address][Specify][Sub-net Mask]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][IPv4 Gateway Address]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Machine IPv6 Address][Manual Configuration Address]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][DNS Configuration][Auto-Obtain (DHCP)]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings  
[Network][DNS Configuration][Specify][DNS Server1-3]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[Network][DDNS Configuration]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Domain Name][Auto-Obtain (DHCP)]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Domain Name][Specify] [Domain Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][WINS Configuration][WINS Server]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][WINS Configuration][Scope ID]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Effective Protocol][IPv4]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:You can make the TCP/IP settings if  
SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin is communicating with the machine using  
IPX/SPX.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Effective Protocol][IPv6]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:You can make the TCP/IP settings if  
SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin is communicating with the machine using  
IPX/SPX.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Machine  
[Network][Effective Protocol][NetWare]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:You can make the IPX/SPX settings if  
SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin is communicating with the machine using  
TCP/IP.  
1
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Effective Protocol][Net BEUI]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Effective Protocol][AppleTalk]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][NCP Delivery Protocol]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][NW Frame Type][Auto Select]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][NW Frame Type][Ethernet II]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][NW Frame Type][Ethernet 802.2]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][NW Frame Type][Ethernet 802.3]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings  
[Network][NW Frame Type][Ethernet SNAP]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[Network][SMB Computer Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][SMB Work Group]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Ethernet Speed]  
• Web Image Monitor:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][LAN Type][Ethernet]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][LAN Type][IEEE 802.11b]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Permit SNMPv3 Communication]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[Network][Permit SSL/TLS Communication]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Machine  
[Network][Host Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[Network][Machine Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][IPv4 Address][Auto-Obtain (DHCP)]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][IPv4 Address][Specify][Machine IPv4 Address]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][IPv4 Address][Specify][Sub-net Mask]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][DDNS Configuration]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][IPv4 over 1394]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][WINS Configuration][WINS Server]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings  
[IEEE 1394][WINS Configuration][Scope ID]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[IEEE 1394][Host Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 1394][Domain Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 802.11b][Communication Mode]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 802.11b][SSID Setting]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 802.11b][Channel]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 802.11b][Security Method]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
[IEEE 802.11b][Transmission Speed]  
• Web Image Monitor:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Machine  
[File Transfer][Delivery Option]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[File Transfer][SMTP Server][Server Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][SMTP Server][Port No.]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][SMTP Authentication]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][POP before SMTP]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Reception Protocol]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][POP3/IMAP4 Settings][Server Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][POP3/IMAP4 Settings][Encryption]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network Settings  
[File Transfer][Administrator's E-mail Address]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[File Transfer][E-mail Communication Port]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][E-mail Reception Interval]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Max. Reception E-mail Size]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][E-mail Storage in Server]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][SMB User Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][SMB Password]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][FTP User Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting the Machine  
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][FTP Password]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
1
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][NCP User Name]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Default User Name/Password (Send)][NCP Password]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message][Program/Change]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message][Delete]  
• Web Image Monitor:Can be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Scanner Resend Interval Time]  
• Web Image Monitor:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
[File Transfer][Number of Scanner Resends]  
• Web Image Monitor:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
• telnet:Cannot be used for specifying the setting.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. System Settings  
This chapter describes various items of [System Settings] available in this ma-  
chine.  
General Features  
This section describes various items of [General Features] under [System Settings].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
For the procedure of entering the [System Settings], see "Accessing User tools  
(System Settings)".  
Program/Change/Delete User Text  
You can register character strings you use frequently when specifying set-  
tings, such as “.com" and “Regards".  
You can register up to 40 items.  
• Program/Change  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Check that [General Features] is selected.  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete User Text].  
D Press [Program/Change]  
E Select the user text you want to change.  
To program new user text, press [Not Programmed].  
F Press [OK].  
G Press [Exit].  
• Delete  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Check that [General Features] is selected.  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete User Text].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Select the user text you want to delete.  
F Press [Clear].  
G Press [Exit].  
Panel Key Sound  
The beeper (key tone) sounds when a key is pressed.  
• Low  
Medium  
• High  
• Off  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
System Settings  
Warm–up Beeper (copier/Document Server)  
You can have the beeper sound when the machine becomes ready to copy af-  
ter leaving Energy Saver mode, or when the power is turned on.  
On  
• Off  
Copy Count Display (copier/Document Server)  
The copy counter can be set to show the number of copies made (count up) or  
the number of copies yet to be made (count down).  
2
Up  
• Down  
Function Priority  
You can specify the mode to be displayed immediately after the operation  
switch is turned on, or when System Reset mode is turned on.  
Copier  
• Document Server  
• Printer  
• Scanner  
Print Priority  
Print Priority is given to the mode selected.  
Display Mode  
• Copier/Document Server  
• Printer  
• Interleave  
• Job Order  
When [Interleave] is selected, the current print job will be interrupted after a  
maximum of five sheets.  
Function Reset Timer  
You can set the length of time the machine waits before changing modes  
when using the multi-access function.  
This is useful if you are making many copies and have to change settings for  
each copy. If you set a longer reset period, you can prevent interruption from  
other functions.  
The default time is three seconds.  
Set Time  
• Immediate  
When you select [Set Time], enter the time (3–30 seconds, in 1 second incre-  
ments) using the number keys.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Features  
Interleave Print  
You can set the timing for functions to switch when [Print Priority] has been set  
to [Interleave].  
Default: 10 sheets  
Depending on printing time, set values may change.  
The timing for functions can be set from 1 to 20 sheets.  
Status Indicator  
You can specify whether the status indicator shows the machine status or not.  
2
On  
• Off  
Screen Color Setting  
You can select the screen color among from five types.  
Blue Type  
• Blue & Gray Type  
• Gray Type  
• Green Type  
• Red Type  
Output: Copier (copier)  
You can specify a tray to which documents are delivered.  
1. Finisher Shift Tray  
2. Finisher Upper Tray  
3. Finisher Booklet Tray  
4. Interposer Lower Tray  
5. Interposer Upper Tray  
6. Tray 3  
7. Tray 2  
8. Tray 1  
9. Tray 6  
10. Tray 5  
11. Tray 4  
12. Tray 7  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Output: Document Server (Document Server)  
You can specify a tray to which documents are delivered.  
• Finisher AFE  
Finisher Upper Tray  
• Finisher Shift Tray  
• Booklet Processor  
Finisher Booklet Tray  
2
Output: Printer (printer)  
You can specify a tray to which documents are delivered.  
The output trays set on the printer driver have priority over the output tray  
specified below.  
• Finisher AFE  
Finisher Upper Tray  
• Finisher Shift Tray  
• Booklet Processor  
Finisher Booklet Tray  
Paper Tray Priority: Copier (copier)  
You can specify the tray to supply paper for output.  
Tray 1  
• Tray 2  
• Tray 3  
• Tray 4  
• Tray 5  
• Tray 6  
• Tray 7  
Paper Tray Priority: Printer (printer)  
You can specify the tray to supply paper for output.  
Tray 1  
• Tray 2  
• Tray 3  
• Tray 4  
• Tray 5  
• Tray 6  
• Tray 7  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Features  
System Status/Job List Display Time  
You can specify how long to display the System Status and Job List display  
for.  
On  
• Off  
By selecting [On], you can specify a display time between 10 and 999 seconds.  
The timing is set to “15 second(s)” by default.  
2
Time Interval between Printing Jobs  
You can set the length of interval between the end of a job and the start of a  
new job.  
If you select “Set Time”, enter the time, 0 - 999 seconds (in 1 second incre-  
ments), using the number keys. Default value is 3 seconds.  
Set Time  
• Do not set  
ADF Original Table Elevation  
You can set the timing for elevating the ADF original table.  
When original is set  
• When [Start] is pressed  
ADF Feed Speed  
When you use thick paper, you can slow down the printing speed to avoid  
fusing the image by selecting [slow].  
Normal  
• Slow  
Optimum for Thick Paper  
You can set the optimum for thick paper to On or Off.  
• On  
Off  
Key Repeat  
You can enable or disable repetition of an operation if a key on the screen or  
control panel is pressed continuously.  
• Off  
Normal  
• Repeat Time: Medium  
• Repeat Time: Long  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Z-fold position  
Set the folding-back position in units of 1 mm when you specify Z-folding.  
The machine is shipped from the factory with this value set to 2 mm (metric  
version) or 0.1 inch (inch version).  
The setting range of the folding position for each paper size is given below:  
• Metric version  
• A3: 2 - 25 mm  
2
• B4 JIS: 2 - 40 mm  
• A4: 2 - 10 mm  
• 11 × 17: 2 - 20 mm  
• 81/2 × 14: 2-35 mm  
• Inch version  
• A3: 0.1 - 1.0 inch  
• B4 JIS: 0.1 - 1.6 inch  
• A4: 0.1 - 0.4 inch  
• 11 × 17: 0.1 - 0.8 inch  
• 81/2 × 14: 0.1 - 1.4 inch  
Note  
If the Panel Key Sound setting is [Off], the beeper does not sound, whatever  
the Warm Up Notice setting.  
The Function Reset Timer setting is ignored if Interleave is set for Print Prior-  
ity.  
Reference  
p.3 “Accessing User Tools (System Settings)”  
"Function Compatibility", Copy/Document Server Reference  
Output tray settings  
Important  
You cannot interrupt the current stapling job even if a stapling job is specified  
by a different function.  
When the 3000-sheet finisher or booklet finisher are installed and stapling or  
shift sorting are specified for a job, the job will be delivered to the finisher  
shift tray regardless of the output tray specified.  
Paper that is fed from the bypass tray cannot be delivered to finisher trays.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Timer Settings  
Timer Settings  
This section describes various items of [Timer Settings] under [System Settings].  
Auto Off Timer  
After a specified period has passed, following job completion, the machine  
automatically turns off, in order to conserve energy. This function is called  
"Auto Off". The machine status after the Auto Off operation is referred to as  
"Off mode", or "Sleep mode". For the Auto Off Timer, specify the time to  
elapse before Auto Off.  
2
The timing is set to "90 minute(s)" (Type 2, 3: 120 minute(s)) by default.  
The time can be set from 10 seconds to 240 minutes, using the number keys.  
Auto Off may not work when error messages appear.  
Energy Saver Timer  
Set the amount of time the machine waits before switching to lower-power  
mode after copying has finished or the last operation is performed.  
The time can be set from 1 to 240 minutes, using the number keys.  
The timing is set to "15 minute(s)" by default.  
Panel Off Timer  
Set the amount of time the machine waits before switching the panel off after  
copying has finished or the last operation is performed.  
The warm up time for making a copy from standby mode is 10 seconds.  
Enter a time interval between 10 seconds and 240 minutes, using the number  
keys.  
The timing is set to "1 minute(s)" by default.  
System Auto Reset Timer  
The System Reset setting automatically switches the screen to that of the func-  
tion set in Function Priority when no operations are in progress, or when an  
interrupted job is cleared. This setting determines the system reset interval.  
On  
• Off  
The time can be set from 10 to 999 seconds, using the number keys  
The timing is set to "60 second(s)" by default.  
Copier/Document Server Auto Reset Timer (copier/Document Server)  
Specifies the time to elapse before copier and Document Server modes reset.  
On  
• Off  
If [Off] is selected, the machine does not automatically switch to the user code  
entry screen.  
The time can be set from 10 to 999 seconds, using the number keys.  
The timing is set to "60 second(s)" by default.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Settings  
Printer Auto Reset Timer (printer)  
Specifies the time to elapse before the printer function resets.  
On  
• Off  
The time can be set from 10 to 999 seconds, using the number keys.  
The timing is set to "60 second(s)" by default.  
Scanner Auto Reset Timer (scanner)  
Specifies the time to elapse before the scanner function resets.  
2
On  
• Off  
If [Off] is selected, the machine will not automatically switch to the user code  
entry screen.  
The time can be set from 10 to 999 seconds, using the number keys.  
The timing is set to "60 second(s)" by default.  
Set Date  
Set the date for the copier's internal clock using the number keys.  
To change between year, month, and day, press [] and [].  
Set Time  
Set the time for the copier's internal clock using the number keys.  
Enter the time using the 24–hour format (in 1 second increments).  
To change between hours, minutes and seconds, press [] and [].  
Auto Logout Timer  
You can specify whether or not to automatically log out a user when the user  
does not operate the machine for a specified period of time after logging in.  
On  
• Off  
When [On] is selected, the time can be set from 60 to 999 seconds, in one sec-  
ond increments, using the number keys.  
The timing is set to "180 second(s)" by default.  
Weekly Timer Code  
Set an eight-digit code to turn the main power on and off at the time set in  
“Weekly Timer”.  
Off  
• On  
If “On” is selected, enter the Weekly Timer Code with number keys. Not do-  
ing so may result in the machine being disabled, even if the power is turned  
on.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Timer Settings  
Weekly Timer: Monday-Sunday  
Set the time to turn on/off the power for each day of the week.  
• Power On Time  
• Power Off Time  
Enter the Power On Time and the Power Off Time using the 24-hour system.  
Enter the "hour" and "minute" using the number keys.  
2
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Interface Settings  
This section describes various items of [Interface Settings] under [System Settings].  
Network  
This section describes various items of [Network] under [Interface Settings].  
2
Machine IPv4 Address  
Before using this machine in the network environment, you must configure  
the IP address and subnet mask.  
When you select [Specify], enter the [Machine IPv4 Address] and [Sub-net Mask]  
as "xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx" ("x" indicates a number).  
If you install the optional IEEE 1394 interface board and use the IEEE 1394 in-  
terface, you must set the address of the domain, different from the [IPv4 Ad-  
dress] of [IEEE 1394]. If you intend to set the address for the same domain, set  
a different value for the [Sub-net Mask].  
When you select [Specify], be sure not to set the same [Machine IPv4 Address] as  
that of another machines on the network.  
The physical address (MAC address) also appears.  
If you use the interface for Ethernet and IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394) at the same  
time, settings must be made carefully.  
Auto-Obtain (DHCP)  
• Specify  
• Machine IPv4 Address: 011.022.033.044  
• Sub-net Mask: 000.000.000.000  
IPv4 Gateway Address  
A gateway is a connection or interchange point between two networks.  
Configure the gateway address for the router or host computer used as a gate-  
way.  
• IPv4 Gateway Address: 000.000.000.000  
Machine IPv6 Address  
You can specify the machine’s IPv6 network address.  
• Link-local Address  
The machine’s specified link-local address appears.  
• manual Configuration Address  
The machine’s manually configuration address appears.  
• Stateless Address: 1-5  
The specified stateless address appears.  
IPv6 Gateway Address  
The machine’s IPv6 gateway address appears.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Interface Settings  
IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration  
You can set “IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration” to “Active” or “Inactive”.  
Active  
• Inactive  
DNS Configuration  
Make settings for the DNS server.  
When you select [Specify], enter the [DNS Server]IP address as “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx"(“x"  
indicates a number).  
2
Auto-Obtain (DHCP)  
• Specify  
• DNS Server 1: 000.000.000.000  
• DNS Server 2: 000.000.000.000  
• DNS Server 3: 000.000.000.000  
DDNS Configuration  
You can specify the DDNS settings.  
Active  
• Inactive  
Domain Name  
You can specify the domain name.  
Auto-Obtain (DHCP)  
• Specify  
WINS Configuration  
You can specify the WINS server settings.  
If [On] is selected, enter the [WINS Server] IP address as “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx"(“x"  
indicates a number).  
If DHCP is in use, specify the [Scope ID].  
Enter a [Scope ID] using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
On  
• Primary WINS Server: 000.000.000.000  
• Secondary WINS Server: 000.000.000.000  
• Scope ID  
• Off  
Effective Protocol  
Select the protocol to use in the network.  
• IPv4: Active / Inactive  
• IPv6: Active / Inactive  
• NetWare: Active / Inactive  
• NetBEUI: Active / Inactive  
• AppleTalk: Active / Inactive  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
NCP Delivery Protocol  
Select the protocol for NCP delivery.  
• IPX Priority  
TCP/IP Priority  
• IPX Only  
• TCP/IP Only  
2
NW Frame Type  
Select the frame type when you use NetWare.  
Auto Select  
• Ethernet II  
• Ethernet 802.2  
• Ethernet 802.3  
• Ethernet SNAP  
SMB Computer Name  
Specify the SMB computer name.  
Enter the computer name using up to 15 alphanumerical characters.  
"*+,/:;<>=?[\]|. and spaces cannot be entered.  
Setting a computer name starting with RNP and rnp is inhibited.  
Use uppercase letters for alphabet.  
SMB Work Group  
Specify the SMB work group.  
Enter the computer name using up to 15 alphanumerical characters.  
"*+,/:;<>=?[\]|. and spaces cannot be entered.  
Use uppercase letters for alphabet.  
Ethernet Speed  
Set the access speed for networks.  
Select a speed that matches your network environment. [Auto Select] should  
usually be selected.  
Auto Select  
• 10Mbps Full Duplex  
• 10Mbps Half Duplex  
• 100Mbps Full Duplex  
• 100Mbps Half Duplex  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Interface Settings  
LAN Type  
When you have installed the optional IEEE 802.11b interface unit, select inter-  
face, IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) or Ethernet.  
Ethernet  
• IEEE 802.11b  
Appears when the optional IEEE 802.11b interface unit is installed.  
If Ethernet and IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) are both connected to the ma-  
chine, the selected interface takes precedence.  
2
Ping Command  
Check the network connection with ping command using given IP address.  
If you fail to connect to the network, check the following, and then retry the  
ping command.  
• Check TCP/IP of the printer is active.  
• Check that the machine with assigned IP address is connected to the net-  
work.  
• There is a possibility that same IP address is used for the specified equip-  
ment.  
Permit SNMPv3 Communication  
Set the encrypted communication of SNMPv3.  
• Encryption Only  
Encryption/Clear Text  
If you set to [Encryption Only], you need to set password for the machine.  
Permit SSL/TLS Communication  
Set the encrypted communication of SSL/TLS.  
• Ciphertext Only  
Ciphertext Priority  
• Ciphertext/Clear Text  
If you set to [Ciphertext Only], you need to install the server authentification for  
the machine.  
Host Name  
Specify the host name.  
Enter the host name using up to 63 alphanumerical characters.  
Machine Name  
Specify the machine name.  
Enter the machine name using up to 31 alphanumerical characters.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Parallel Interface  
This section describes various items of [Parallel Interface] under [Interface Settings].  
[Parallel Interface] is displayed when this machine is installed with the IEEE 1284  
interface board (optional).  
Parallel Timing  
Sets the timing for the control signal of the parallel interface.  
2
ACK outside  
• ACK inside  
• STB down  
Parallel Communication Speed  
Sets the communication speed for the parallel interface.  
High Speed  
• Standard  
Selection Signal Status  
Sets the level for the select signal of the parallel interface.  
High  
• Low  
Input Prime  
Sets whether to validate or invalidate the input prime signal upon receipt.  
• Active  
Inactive  
Bidirectional Communication  
Sets the printer's response mode to a status acquisition request when using a  
parallel interface.  
On  
• Off  
When set to [Off], bidirectional communication function will be disabled. Al-  
so, printer driver will not be installed under Windows Auto Detect function.  
Signal Control  
Sets procedure to error during printing.  
Job Acceptance Priority  
• Printer Priority  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Interface Settings  
IEEE 1394  
This section describes various items of [IEEE 1394] under [Interface Settings].  
[IEEE 1394] is displayed when this machine is installed with the IEEE 1394 inter-  
face board (optional).  
IPv4 Address  
When you connect the machine to a network using the IEEE 1394 interface,  
you must configure the IP address and subnet mask.  
2
When you select [Specify], enter the [Machine IPv4 Address] and [Sub-net Mask]  
as “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”(“x” indicates a number).  
When you use the IEEE 1394 interface on a network, you cannot use the Eth-  
ernet interface in the same domain. To use both interfaces in the same do-  
main, set different values for the [Sub-net Mask].  
If you use the interface for Ethernet and IEEE 1394 (IP over 1394) at the same  
time, settings must be made carefully.  
Auto-Obtain (DHCP)  
• Specify  
• Machine IPv4 Address: 000.000.000.000  
• Sub-net Mask: 000.000.000.000  
DDNS Configuration  
You can specify the DDNS settings.  
Active  
• Inactive  
Host Name  
Specify the host name.  
Enter the host name using up to 63 alphanumerical characters.  
Domain Name  
Make settings for the domain name.  
Auto-Obtain (DHCP)  
• Specify  
Enter the domain name using up to 63 alphanumerical characters.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Settings  
WINS Configuration  
You can specify the WINS server settings.  
If [On] is selected, specify the [WINS Server] IP address as “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx"  
(“xxx" indicates a number).  
If DHCP is in use, specify the [Scope ID].  
Enter [Scope ID] using up to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
On  
• Primary WINS Server: 000.000.000.000  
2
• Secondary WINS Server: 000.000.000.000  
• Scope ID  
• Off  
IPv4 over 1394  
When you use the IP over 1394 function of the IEEE 1394 interface to connect  
the machine to the network, or you print from computer with the IP over 1394  
driver, you must specify [Active] for [IP over 1394].  
Active  
• Inactive  
Printing with IP over 1394 is possible under Windows Me/XP and Windows  
Server 2003.  
SCSI print (SBP-2)  
When you print using the SCSI print client function supported by Windows  
2000/XP, or Windows Server 2003, you must set [SCSI print (SBP-2)].  
Active  
• Inactive  
Bidirectional SCSI print  
Specifies the printer's response mode etc. for status requests when using the  
IEEE 1394 interface.  
On  
• Off  
If this is set to [Off] bidirectional communication will not work.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Interface Settings  
IEEE 802.11b  
This section describes various items of [IEEE 802.11b] under [Interface Settings].  
[IEEE 802.11b] is displayed when this machine is installed with the wireless LAN  
interface board (optional).  
Implement respective settings simultaneously.  
2
Communication Mode  
Be sure to make all settings simultaneously.  
802.11 Ad-hoc  
• Ad-hoc  
• Infrastructure  
SSID Setting  
Specifies SSID to distinguish the access point in infrastructure mode or 802.11  
ad-hoc mode.  
The characters that can be used are ASCII 0x20-0x7e (32 bytes).  
If blank is specified in 802.11b ad-hoc mode or ad-hoc mode, “ASSID" ap-  
pears.  
Channel  
Specifies a channel when you select 802.11b ad-hoc mode or ad-hoc mode.  
The following channels are available:  
• Metric version: 1-14  
• Inch version: 1-11  
Security Method  
Specifies the encryption of the IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN).  
If set to [WEP], always enter WEP key. If set to [WPA], set encryption method  
and authentication method.  
You can specify “WPA”, if you set [Communication Mode] to [Infrastructure].  
Off  
• WEP  
• WPA  
• WPA Encryption Method  
Select either "TKIP" or "CCMP(AES)".  
• WPA Authent. Method  
Select either "WPA-PSK" or "WPA802.1X)". If you have selected “WPA-  
PSK”, enter the pre-shared key (PSK) of 8- 63 characters in ASCII code.  
Wireless LAN Signal  
Shows the radio wave conditions of the access point connected in infrastruc-  
ture mode.  
Radio wave status is displayed when you press [Wireless LAN Signal].  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Settings  
Transmission Speed  
Specifies the communication speed of the IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN).  
Auto Select  
• 11Mbps Fixed  
• 5.5Mbps Fixed  
• 2Mbps Fixed  
• 1Mbps Fixed  
2
Restore Factory Defaults  
You can return the IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN) settings to their defaults.  
• No  
• Yes  
Print List  
You can check items related to the network in use.  
The configuration page shows the current network settings and network infor-  
mation.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Interface Settings].  
C Press [Print List].  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Interface Settings  
D Press the {Start} key.  
The configuration page is printed.  
E Press [Exit].  
F Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
2
You can also exit by pressing [Exit] on the User Tools main menu.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
File Transfer  
This section describes various items of [File Transfer] under [System Settings].  
Delivery Option  
Enables or disables sending stored or scanned documents to ScanRouter V2  
delivery server.  
2
• On  
• Main Delivery Server IPv4 Address: 000.000.000.000  
• Sub Delivery Server IPv4 Address: 000.000.000.000  
Off  
Set this option when specifying whether or not to use ScanRouter V2. If you  
do, you will have to re-register I/O devices in ScanRouter V2.  
Capture Server IP Address  
Specify the capture server IP address.  
This setting appears when the media link board is installed, and that the cap-  
ture function is being used by the ScanRouter V2.  
SMTP Server  
If DNS is in use, enter the host name.  
If DNS is not in use, enter the SMTP server IP address.  
• Server Name  
• Port No.  
Enter the [Server Name] using up to 127 alphanumeric characters. Spaces can-  
not be used.  
Enter [Port No.] between 1 and 65535 using the number keys, and then press  
the {#} key.  
The Port No. is set to 25 by default.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
File Transfer  
SMTP Authentication  
You can configure SMTP authentication (PLAIN, LOGIN, CRAMMD5, DI-  
GEST-MD5).  
When sending e-mail to an SMTP server, you can enhance the SMTP server secu-  
rity level by authentication that requires entering the user name and password.  
If the SMTP server requires authentication, set [SMTP Authentication] to [On],  
and then specify [User Name], [Password], and [Encryption].  
• SMTP Authentication  
2
• On  
User Name  
Enter [User Name] using up to 191 alphanumeric characters. Spaces can-  
not be used. Depending on the SMTP server type, "realm" must be spec-  
ified. Add "@" after the user name, as in "user name@realm".  
E-mail Address  
Password  
Enter [Password] using up to 63 alphanumeric characters. Spaces cannot  
be used.  
Encryption: Auto / On / Off  
[Encryption]-[Auto]: If the authentication method is PLAIN, LOGIN,  
CRAM-MD5, or DIGEST-MD5.  
[Encryption]-[On]: If the authentication method is CRAMMD5 or DI-  
GEST-MD5.  
[Encryption]-[Off]: If the authentication method is PLAIN, or LOGIN.  
Off  
POP before SMTP  
You can configure POP authentication (POP before SMTP).  
When sending e-mail to an SMTP server, you can enhance the SMTP server  
security level by connecting to the POP server for authentication.  
To enable POP server authentication before sending e-mail via the SMTP  
server, set [POP before SMTP] to [On]. E-mail is sent to the SMTP server after the  
time specified for [Wait Time after Authent.] has elapsed.  
If you select [On], enter [Server Name] in [POP3/IMAP4 Setting]. Also, check the  
port number for [POP3] in [E-mail Communication Port].  
• On  
• Wait Time after Authent.  
Using the number keys, you can set [Wait Time after Authent.] from zero to  
10,000 milliseconds, in increments of one millisecond. The timing is set  
to 300msec by default.  
• User Name  
Enter [User Name] using up to 63 alphanumeric characters. Spaces can-  
not be used.  
• E-mail Address  
• Password  
Enter [Password] using up to 63 alphanumeric characters. Spaces cannot  
be used.  
Off  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Reception Protocol  
Specify Reception Protocol for the function "Auto E-mail Notification". For  
details about the function "Auto E-mail Notification", see the Web Image-  
Monitor Help.  
POP3  
• IMAP4  
• SMTP  
2
POP3/IMAP4 Settings  
Specify the POP3/IMAP4 server name for sending or receiving E-mail.The  
specified POP3/IMAP4 server name is used for [POP before SMTP].  
• Server Name  
If DNS is in use, enter the host name. If DNS is not in use, enter the  
POP3/IMAP4 or server IP address. Enter POP3/IMAP4 [Server Name] us-  
ing up to 127 alphanumeric characters. Spaces cannot be used.  
• Encryption  
Auto  
Password encryption is automatically set according to the POP/IMAP  
server settings.  
• On  
Encrypt password.  
• Off  
Do not encrypt password.  
Administrator's E-mail Address  
On e-mailed scanned documents, if the sender is not specified this appears as  
the sender's address.  
If you have specified the user name and e-mail address in [SMTP Authentica-  
tion], make sure to specify this setting.  
Enter within up to 128 alphanumerical characters.  
On e-mailed scanned documents, if [Auto Specify Sender Name] is [Off], specify  
the sender.  
E-mail Communication Port  
Specify the port numbers for sending or receiving E-mail. The specified  
POP3port number is used for [POP before SMTP].  
• POP3: 110  
• IMAP4: 143  
• SMTP: 25  
Enter a port number between 1 and 65535 using the number keys, and then  
press the [#] key.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File Transfer  
E-mail Reception Interval  
Specify, in minutes, the time interval for the function "Auto E-mail Notifica-  
tion" via POP3 or IMAP4 server. For details about the function "Auto E-mail  
Notification", see the Web ImageMonitor Help.  
On: 15 minute(s)  
• Off  
If [On] is selected, the number of times can be set from 2 to 1440 in increments  
of one minute, using the number keys.  
2
Max. Reception E-mail Size  
Specify the maximum reception e-mail size for the function "Auto E-mailNo-  
tification". For details about the function "Auto E-mail Notification", see the  
Web ImageMonitor Help.  
2MB  
Using the number keys, enter a size from one to 50 MB in increments of one  
megabyte.  
E-mail Storage in Server  
Specify whether or not to store received e-mails of the function "Auto E-mail-  
Notification" on the POP3 or IMAP4 server.For details about the function  
"Auto E-mail Notification", see the Web ImageMonitor Help.  
Off  
• All  
• Errors Only  
Default User Name/Password (Send)  
You can specify the user name and password required when sending scan file  
directly to a shared folder on a computer running Windows, to an FTP server,  
or to a NetWare server.  
• SMB User Name  
• SMB Password  
• FTP User Name  
• FTP Password  
• NCP User Name  
• NCP Password  
Enter in up to 128 alphanumerical characters.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message  
You can program, change, or delete the e-mail message used when sending  
scan file as an attachment.  
• Program/Change  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [File Transfer].  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message].  
D Press [Program/Change].  
E Press [Not Programmed].  
F Press [Change].  
2
G Enter a name, and the press [OK].  
Enter the name using up to 20 alphanumerical characters.  
H Press [Edit].  
To start a new line, press [OK] to return to the e-mail message screen,  
and then press [T] in "Select Line to Edit:".  
I Enter the text, and then press [OK].  
Enter up to five lines of text. Each line can consist of up to 80 alphanu-  
meric characters.  
J Press [OK].  
K Press [Exit].  
• Delete  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [File Transfer].  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete E-mail Message].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Select the e-mail message to delete.  
The confirmation message about deleting appears.  
F Press [Yes].  
Auto Specify Sender Name  
Set whether or not to specify the name of the sender when sending e-mail.  
• On  
If you select [On], the specified e-mail address will appear in the “From:"  
box. If you do not specify the sender’s address, the administrator’s e-mail  
address will appear in the “From:" box.  
Off  
If you select [Off], the specified e-mail address will appear in the “From:" box,  
but you cannot send e-mail without specifying the sender’s e-mail address.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File Transfer  
Scanner Resend Interval Time  
Specifies the interval the machine waits before resending scan file, if they can-  
not be sent to the delivery server or mail server.  
The timing is set to "300 second(s)" by default.  
The interval time can be set from 60 to 900 seconds in one second increments,  
using the number keys.  
This setting is for the scanner function.  
Number of Scanner Resends  
Sets a maximum number of times scan file is resent to the delivery server or  
mail server.  
2
On: 3 time(s)  
• Off  
If [On] is selected, the number of times can be set from 1 to 99 using the num-  
ber keys. This setting is for the scanner function.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Administrator Tools  
This section describes various items of [Administrator Tools] under [System Set-  
tings].  
Administrator Tools are used by the administrator. To change these settings,  
contact the administrator.  
We recommend specifying Administrator Authentication before making Ad-  
ministrator Tools settings.  
2
Address Book Management  
You can add, change or delete information registered in the Address Book.  
For details, see “Address Book”.  
• Program/Change  
You can register and change names as well as user codes.  
• Names  
You can register a name, key display, registration number, and title se-  
lection.  
• Auth. Info  
You can register a user code, and specify the functions available to each  
user code. You can also register user names and passwords to be used  
when sending e-mail, sending files to folders, or accessing an LDAP  
server.  
• Protection  
You can register a protection code.  
• E-mail  
You can register an e-mail address.  
• Folder  
You can register the protocol, SMB, FTP, NCP, path.  
• Add to Group  
You can put names registered in the Address Book into a group.  
• Delete  
You can delete a name from the Address Book.  
You can register up to 2,000 names.  
You can register up to 500 user codes.  
You can also register and manage names in the Address Book using Web Im-  
age Monitor or SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin.  
Use SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin provided with the printer scanner unit.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Administrator Tools  
Address Book: Program/Change/Delete Group  
Names registered in the Address Book can be added into a group.  
You can then easily manage the names registered in each group.  
• Program/Change  
You can register and change groups.  
• Names  
You can register a name, key display, registration number, and title se-  
lection.  
2
• Programmed User/Group  
You can check the names or groups registered in each group.  
• Protection  
You can register a protection code.  
• Add to Group  
You can put groups registered in the Address Book into a group.  
• Delete  
You can delete a group from the Address Book.  
You can register up to 100 groups.  
You can also register and manage groups in the Address Book using Web Im-  
age Monitor or SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin.  
Use SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin provided with the printer scanner unit.  
Address Book: Change Order  
Changes the order of registered name.  
You can rearrange the order of items on the same page, but you cannot move  
items to another page.  
For example, you cannot move an item from “PLANNING” ([OPQ]) to “DAI-  
LY” ([CD]).  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Change Order].  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
D Press the name key to be move.  
2
You can select a name using the number keys.  
E Press the name key in the place you want to move to.  
The selected user key is moved to the selected position, and the user key  
currently at the selected position is moved forward or backward.  
If you move the selected user key forward, the user key currently at the se-  
lected position is moved backward.  
If you move the selected user key backward, the user key currently at the  
selected position is moved forward.  
You can also select a name using the number keys.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Administrator Tools  
Print Address Book: Destination List  
You can print the destination list registered in the Address Book.  
• Print in Title 1 Order  
Prints the Address Book in Title 1 order.  
• Print in Title 2 Order  
Prints the Address Book in Title 2 order.  
• Print in Title 3 Order  
2
Prints the Address Book in Title 3 order.  
• Print Group Dial List  
Prints the group Address Book.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Print Address Book: Destination List].  
D Select the print format.  
E To print the list on two-sided pages, select [Print on 2 Sides].  
F Press the {Start} key.  
The list prints out.  
Address Book: Edit Title  
You can edit the title to easily find a user.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Edit Title].  
D Press the title key you want to change.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
E Enter the new name, and then press [OK].  
F Press [OK].  
Address Book: Switch Title  
Specifies the title to select a name.  
Title 1  
• Title 2  
• Title 3  
2
Back Up / Restore Address Book  
You can back up the machine’s address book to external storage or restore the  
backup copy from the external storage.  
• Back Up  
You can back up the machine’s address book to external storage.  
• Restore  
You can restore the backup copy of the address book from external storage.  
• Format  
You can format the external storage.  
• Obtain Media Info  
The free space and occupied space of the external storage are displayed.  
Display / Print Counter  
Allows you to view and print the number of prints.  
• Display/Print Counter  
Displays the number of prints for each function (Total, and Copier, Printer,  
A3/DLT, Duplex, Send/TX Total Color, Send/TX Total Black & White,  
Scanner Send Color, Scanner Send Black & White, GPC, GPC Printer).  
• Print Counter List  
Prints out a list of the number of prints made under each function.  
Display / Clear / Print Counter per User  
Allows you to view and print the numbers of prints accessed with user codes,  
and to set those values to 0.  
Press [UPrevious] and [TNext] to show all the numbers of prints.  
The number of prints may differ from the counter value shown in Display /  
Print Counter.  
• Print Counter  
• Print Counter List for All Users  
Prints the counter values for all the users.  
• Clear Counter for All Users  
Sets the counter value for all the users.  
• Print Counter List per User  
Prints the counter values for each user.  
• Clear Counter per User  
Sets the counter value for each user.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Administrator Tools  
• Scanner Counter  
• Print Counter List for All Users  
Prints the counter values for all the users.  
• Clear Counter for All Users  
Sets the counter value for all the users.  
• Print Counter List per User  
Prints the counter values for each user.  
2
• Clear Counter per User  
Sets the counter value for each user.  
User Authentication Management  
• User Code Auth.  
Using User Code Authentication, you can limit the available functions and  
supervise their use.  
When using User Code Authentication, register the user code.  
Using the Printer PC Control function, you can obtain a log of prints cor-  
responding to the codes entered using the printer driver.  
If User Code Authentication has been specified, Auto color Selection can-  
not be used.  
For details about Basic Authentication, Windows Authentication, LDAP  
Authentication, and Integration Server Authentication, consult your ad-  
ministrator.  
• Functions to Restrict  
• Copier  
• Printer  
• Document Server  
• Printer: PC Control  
• Scanner  
• Printer Job Authentication  
• Entire  
• Simple (Limitation)  
• Simple (All)  
• Basic Auth.  
• Windows Auth.  
• LDAP Auth.  
• Integration Svr. Auth.  
Off  
Enhanced Authentication Management  
For details about this function, consult your administrator.  
Administrator Authentication Management  
For details about this function, consult your administrator.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Settings  
Program/Change Administrator  
For details about this function, consult your administrator.  
Key Counter Management  
You can specify that functions that you want to manage with the key counter.  
• Copier  
• Document Server  
• Printer  
2
• Scanner  
Extended Security  
You can specify whether or not to use the extended security functions. For de-  
tails about the extended security functions, consult your administrator.  
Auto Delete File in Document Server  
You can specify whether documents stored in the Document Server will or  
will not be deleted after a specified period of time.  
On: 3 day(s)  
• Off  
If you select [On], documents stored subsequently are deleted after the speci-  
fied period.  
If you select [Off], documents are not automatically deleted.  
If you select [On], enter a number of days from 1 to 180 (in 1 day increments).  
The default is 3 days, this means documents are deleted 3 days (72 hours) af-  
ter they are stored.  
Delete All Files in Document Server  
You can delete files stored in the Document Server, including files stored for  
Sample Print, Locked Print, Hold Print, and Stored Print under the printer  
function.  
• No  
• Yes  
Even if a password is always set, all documents are deleted.  
A confirmation message appears. To delete all documents, select [Yes].  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Administrator Tools  
Program / Change / Delete LDAP Server  
Program the LDAP server to find up e-mail destinations in the LDAP server  
Address Book directly. This function is possible when sending scan files by e-  
mail using the scanner.  
• Name  
• Server Name  
• Search Base  
2
• Port Number  
• Use Secure Connection (SSL)  
• Authentication  
• Search Conditions  
• Search Options  
To start an LDAP search, make sure that the items listed below are set. For  
other items, check your environment and make any necessary changes.  
• Server Name  
• Search Base  
• Port Number  
• Search Conditions  
• Authentication method selection  
To use the LDAP server in Administrator Tools, select [On] under LDAP server.  
This function supports LDAP Version 2.0 and 3.0. Ver 2.0 does not support  
High Security authentication.  
• Program/Change  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools], and then press [TNext] twice.  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete LDAP Server].  
D Select the LDAP server you want to program or change.  
When programming the server, select [Not Programmed].  
E Set each item as necessary.  
F Press [OK] after setting each item.  
G Press [Exit] twice.  
H Press the {User Tools} key.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
• Delete  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools], and then press [TNext] twice.  
C Press [Program/Change/Delete LDAP Server].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Select the LDAP server you want to delete.  
F Press [Yes].  
2
G Press [Exit].  
H Press the {User Tools} key.  
LDAP Search  
You can specify whether or not to use the LDAP server for searching.  
Off  
• On  
If you select [Off], [Search LDAP] will not appear on the searching display.  
AOF (Always On)  
Specify whether or not to use Auto Off.  
On  
• Off  
Firmware Version  
You can check the version of the software installed in this machine.  
Network Security Level  
For details about this function, consult your administrator.  
Transfer Log Setting  
For details about this function, consult your administrator.  
p.192 “Printing the Counter for Each User”  
p.238 “Counter”  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Administrator Tools  
Program / Change / Delete LDAP Server  
This section explains how to specify the LDAP server settings.  
To program / change the LDAP server  
A Press [System Settings].  
2
B Press [Administrator Tools], and then press [TNext] twice.  
C Press [Program / Change / Delete LDAP Server].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the LDAP server you want to program or change.  
When programming the server, select [Not Programmed].  
F Set each item as necessary.  
G Press [OK] after setting each item.  
For details about LDAP server, see "Programming the LDAP server".  
H Press [Exit].  
I Press the {User Tools} key.  
Reference  
p.78 “Programming the LDAP server”  
To delete the programmed LDAP server  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools], and then press [TNext] twice.  
C Press [Program / Change / Delete LDAP Server].  
D Press [Delete] is selected.  
E Select the LDAP server you want to delete.  
F Press [Yes].  
G Press [Exit].  
H Press the {User Tools} key.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System Settings  
Programming the LDAP server  
This section explains how to specify the LDAP server settings.  
To enter an identification name  
A Press [Change] under “Name”.  
2
Register a name for the LDAP server that will appear on the server selection  
screen of the LDAP search operation.  
B Enter the server’s identification name.  
C Press [OK].  
To enter a server name  
A Press [Change] under “Server Name”.  
Register the LDAP server’s host name or IPv4 address.  
B Enter the LDAP server name.  
C Press [OK].  
To enter the search base  
A Press [Change] under “Search Base”.  
Select a route folder to start the search from e-mail addresses registered in the  
selected folder are search targets.  
B Enter the search base.  
For example, if the search target is the sales department of ABC company, en-  
ter “dc=sales department, o=ABC”. (In this example, the description is for an  
active directory. “dc” is for the organization unit, and “o” is for the company.)  
Search base registration may be required depending on your server environ-  
ment. When registration is required, unspecified searches will result in error.  
Check you server environment and enter any required specifications.  
C Press [OK].  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Administrator Tools  
To enter a port number  
A Press [Change] under ““Port No.”.  
Specify the port number for communicating with the LDAP server. Specify a  
port that is compliant with your environment.  
B Enter the port number using the number keys, and then press the {#} key.  
2
When SSL is set to [On], the port number automatically changes to “636”.  
To start SSL communication  
A Press [On].  
Use SSL to communicate with the LDAP server.  
To use SSL, the LDAP server must support SSL.  
When SSL is set to [On], the port number automatically changes to "689".  
SSL setting must be enabled on this machine. For details, consult your net-  
work administrator.  
B Enter the port number using the number keys, and then press the {#} key.  
When SSL is set to [On], the port number automatically changes to “636”.  
To set authentication  
A Press [TNext].  
B Press [On] or [High Security] under “Authentication”.  
To make a search request to the LDAP server, use the administrator account  
for authentication.  
Authentication settings must comply with your server’s authentication set-  
tings. Check your server settings before setting this machine.  
[High Security] is available only with LDAP Version 3.0.  
When [High Security] is selected, the administrator password is encrypted be-  
fore it is sent to the network. When [On] is selected, the password is sent with-  
out encryption.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
To enter the user name and password  
A Press [Change] under “Name”.  
When [On] or [High Security] is selected for the authentication setting, use the  
administrator account name and password. Do not enter the administrator  
account name and password when using authentication for each individual  
or each search.  
2
B Enter the user name, and then press [OK].  
Procedures for the user name setting differ depending on server environ-  
ment. Check your server environment before making the setting.  
Example: Domain Name\User Name, User Name@Domain Name,  
CN=Name, OU=Department Name, DC=Server Name  
C Press [Change] under “Password”.  
D Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
The user name and password are required for administrator authentication to  
access the LDAP server.  
You can set the user name and password in this machine's Address Book to  
allow individual authentication access to the LDAP server. Use Administra-  
tor Tools to select the user name and password you want to use.  
To test the connection  
A Press [Connection Test].  
Access the LDAP server to check the proper connection is established. Check  
authentication works according to the authentication settings.  
A connection test is carried out.  
B Press [OK].  
If the connection test fails, check your settings and try again.  
This function does not check search conditions or the search base.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Administrator Tools  
To set search conditions  
A Press [TNext] twice.  
B Press [Change] for items you want to use as search conditions from the fol-  
lowing: [Name], [E-mail Address], [Company Name], and [Department Name].  
You can enter an attribute as a typical search keyword. Using the entered at-  
tribute, the function searches the LDAP server’s Address Book.  
2
C Enter the attribute you want to use when searching for e-mail addresses,  
and then press [OK].  
The attribute value may change depending on the server environment. Check  
the attribute value complies with your server environment before setting it.  
You can leave items blank, but you cannot leave attributes blank when  
searching for e-mail addresses from the LDAP server Address Book.  
To set search options  
A Press [TNext] three times.  
B Press [Change] under "Attribute".  
C Enter the attribute you want to use when searching for e-mail addresses,  
and then press [OK].  
To search the LDAP server data using a keyword other than prepared key-  
words such as Name, E-mail Address, Company Name, and Department  
Name, specify the attribute for the keyword registered in your LDAP server,  
and the name to be displayed on the control panel during the search. For ex-  
ample, to search e-mail addresses by employee number, enter “employ-  
eeNo.” in the Attribute field, and “Employee No.” in the key display field.  
The attribute value may change depending on the server environment. Check  
the attribute complies with your server environment before setting it.  
D Press [Change] under "Key Display".  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
E Enter the key display, and then press [OK].  
The registered “key display” appears as a keyword for searching LDAP.  
• Without key display registration  
2
• With key display registration  
The key does not appear on the search screen unless both “Attribute” and  
“Key Display” are registered. Make sure you register both to use the optional  
search.  
Reference  
p.233 “LDAP Authentication”  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings on Main and Sub-machines  
System Settings on Main and Sub-machines  
This section explains the System Settings on the two machines during Connect  
Copy.  
While combined copying is under way, the {User Tools} keys of the sub-ma-  
chines remain disabled. If it is desired to change the defaults, press [Combined  
Copying] that appears in reverse video on the control screen of the main machine,  
and then, clear the combined copying before making changes.  
2
General Features  
How the defaults in the General Features of copying of the main and sub-ma-  
chines are used in combined copying will be explained.  
Program/Change/Delete User Text  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Panel Key Sound  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Warm Up Notice (copier/Document Server)  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Copy Count Display (copier/Document Server)  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• The copy counter is always displayed as Up (count up).  
Function Priority  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• When the Auto Reset time of the main machine has lapsed, Connect Copy  
will be cancelled. After that, the machine switches back to the mode select-  
ed in Function Priority upon reaching the System Reset time.  
Print Priority  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• When the Auto Reset time of the main machine has lapsed, Connect Copy  
will be cancelled. After that, the machine switches back to the mode select-  
ed in Function Priority upon reaching the System Reset time.  
Function Reset Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
System Settings  
Interleave Print  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Output: Copier  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Output: Document Server  
2
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Output: Printer  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
ADF Original Table Elevation  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
System Status/Job List Display Time  
The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Key Repeat  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Z-fold Position  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• Make the same settings on both machines.  
Timer Settings  
How the defaults in the Timer Settings of copying of the main and sub-machines  
are used in combined copying will be explained.  
Auto Off Timer  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Energy Saver Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• In Connect Copy mode, neither machine will enter Energy Saver modes  
(Low Power mode, or Energy Saver mode).  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Settings on Main and Sub-machines  
Power Off Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• In Connect Copy mode, neither machine will enter Energy Saver modes  
(Low Power mode, or Energy Saver mode). When the preset time elapses  
after the combined copying is cleared, the machines will transit to the pow-  
er-saving status.  
2
System Auto Reset Timer  
• The set values of the main machine do not affect the combined copying.  
The sub-machines can be used with the interruption copying function  
only.  
• When the sub-machines is copying by interruption, the interruption copy-  
ing is cleared as the time period set on the sub-machines elapses.  
Copy/Document Server Auto Reset Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Printer Auto Reset Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Scanner Auto Reset Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Set Date  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Set Time  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Auto Logout Timer  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Weekly Timer Code  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Weekly Timer: Monday-Sunday  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• In Connect Copy mode, Weekly timer settings on the sub-machine will be  
disabled.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Administrator Tools  
How the defaults in the Administrator Tools of copying of the main and sub-ma-  
chines are used in combined copying will be explained.  
Address Book Management  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
2
Address Book: Program/Change/Delete Group  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Address Book: Change Order  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Print Address Book: Destination List  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Address Book: Edit Title  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Address Book: Select Title  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Back Up / Restore Address Book  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Display/Print Counter  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Display/Clear/Print Counter per User  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
User Authentication Management  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System Settings on Main and Sub-machines  
Enhanced Authentication Management  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Administrator Authentication Management  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
2
Program/Change Administrator  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Key Counter Management  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• In combined copying, management performed using the coin rack or a pre-  
set keycard can only be done by using the adding method.  
Extended Security  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Auto Delete File in Document Server  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Delete All Files in Document Server  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Program/Change/Delete LDAP Server  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
LDAP Search  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
AOF (Always On)  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• During combined copying, neither the main machine nor the sub-ma-  
chines is automatically switched off. Once the combined copying is  
cleared, the power is cut off as the time period set in "Auto-Off Time Set-  
ting" elapses in accordance with the setting of AOF.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System Settings  
Firmware Version  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Network Security Level  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
2
Auto Erase Memory Setting  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Erase All Memory  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Delete All Logs  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Transfer Log Setting  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Data Security for Copying  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Back Up Printing: Delete All Documents  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Back Up Printing: Settings for Compressing  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Settings for Back Up Printing: Initial Values for Types  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Settings for Back Up Printing: Initial Values for Resolution  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Tray Paper Settings  
This section describes various items of {Tray Paper Settings} available in this ma-  
chine. If the specified paper size differs from the actual size of the paper loaded  
in the paper tray, a misfeed might occur because the correct paper size was not  
detected.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Changing Tray Paper Settings  
This section describes how to change the settings of Tray Paper Settings.  
A Press the {Tray Paper Settings} key.  
APD017S  
B Select the tray that you want to change the settings.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Tray Paper Settings  
C Change settings, and then press [OK].  
3
Quitting Tray Paper Settings  
This section describes how to change the settings of Tray Paper Settings.  
A Press the {Tray Paper Settings} key.  
APD017S  
Note  
You can also quit Tray Paper Settings by pressing [Exit].  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
Tray 1  
You can set the display to show the type of paper loaded the tray 1 (LCT).  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the paper tray.  
The paper types  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
3
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Bond Paper  
• Cardstock  
• Prepunched Paper  
The paper sizes (without the LCT, A3 / 11”×17” Tray Unit TK5000)  
"11×81/2K", "A4K"  
Note  
The paper size is fixed for a paper size. It is not available to change the size.  
The paper sizes (utilizing the LCT, A3 / 11”×17” Tray Unit TK5000)  
"11×17L", "81/2×14L", "81/2×11L", "11×81/2K", "A3L", "A4K", "A4L",  
"B4 JISL"  
Custom Size: 210.0 - 305.0 mm (vertically) and 210 - 439.0 mm (horizontally).  
Note  
The paper guide of the optional LCT is fixed for a paper size. Contact  
your service representative if you need to change the paper size.  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tray Paper Settings  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
Thick Paper Setting  
If the LCT (A3 / 11”×17” Tray Unit TK5000) is utilized, this function is not  
available.  
3
• On  
Off  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
3
Tray 2 - 3  
You can set the display to show the type of paper loaded in each of the trays  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
The paper types  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Bond Paper  
• Cardstock  
• Prepunched Paper  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
The paper sizes  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×15L", "11×14L", "10×15L",  
"10×14L", "81/2×14L", "81/2×13L", "81/2×11L", "11×"81/2K", "81/4×14L",  
"81/4×13L", "8×13L", "8×10L", "71/4×101/2L", "101/2×71/4L",  
"51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K", "A3L", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B4 JISL", "B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size:  
• Metric version: Max. 330.2 mm (vertically) and 458.0 mm (horizontally).  
• Inch version: Max. 13.00 inch (vertically) and 18.03 inch (horizontally).  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
3
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
Thick Paper Setting  
• On  
Off  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
3
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Tray 4  
You can set the display to show the type of paper loaded in the tray 4.  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
3
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
"Auto Detect", "11×81/2K", "81/2×51/2K", "51/2×81/2L", "A4K", "A5K",  
"A5L", "B5 JISK"  
Custom Size: 139.0 - 230.0 mm (vertically) and 210.0 - 305.0 mm (horizon-  
tally)  
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
• Metric version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15L", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size: 100.0 - 330.2 mm (vertically) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (hori-  
zontally)  
3
Note  
The paper width between 100 and 139.7 mm are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "B5 JISK",  
"A5K", "A5L".  
• Inch version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15L", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L"  
Custom Size: 3.93 - 13.00 inch (vertically) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizon-  
tally)  
Note  
The paper width between 3.93 and 5.50 inch are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"81/2×11L", "81/2×51/2K", "51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L",  
"B4 JISL", "A4K", "B5 JISK", "A5L".  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Thick Paper Setting  
• On  
Off  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
3
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Tray 5  
You can sets the display to show the type of paper loaded in each of the tray 5  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
3
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Label Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
3
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Label Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
"Auto Detect", "11×81/2L", "81/2×51/2L", "51/2×81/2K", "A4K", "A5K",  
"A5L", "B5 JISK"  
Custom Size: 139.0 - 230.0 mm (vertically) and 210.0 - 305.0 mm (horizon-  
tally)  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
• Metric version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K", "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size: 100.0 - 330.2 mm (vertically) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (hori-  
zontally)  
Note  
3
The paper width between 100 and 139.7 mm are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L",  
"B5 JISK", "A5K", "A5L".  
• Inch version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L"  
Custom Size: 3.93 - 13.00 inch (vertically) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizon-  
tally)  
Note  
The paper width between 3.93 and 5.50 inch are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"81/2×11L", "81/2×51/2K", "51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L",  
"B4 JISL", "A4K", "B5 JISK", "A5L".  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
Thick Paper Setting  
• On  
Off  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
3
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Tray 6  
You can set the display to show the type of paper loaded the tray 6  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
3
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
The paper types utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper types are available as follows:  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5000 (A4 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5000 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
"11×81/2K", "81/2×51/2K", "51/2×81/2L", "A4K", "A5K", "A5L", "B5 JISK"  
Custom Size: 139.0 - 230.0 mm (vertically) and 210.0 - 305.0 mm (horizontally)  
3
The paper sizes utilizing LCIT RT5010 (A3 LCT)  
If the LCIT RT5010 is utilized, the paper sizes are available as follows:  
• Metric version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size: 100.0 - 330.2 mm (vertically) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (hori-  
zontally)  
Note  
The paper width between 100 and 139.7 mm are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L",  
"B5 JISK", "A5K", "A5L".  
• Inch version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K", "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L"  
Custom Size: 3.93 - 13.00 inch (vertically) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizontally)  
Note  
The paper width between 3.93 and 5.50 inch are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"81/2×11L", 81/2×51/2K", 51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L",  
"B4 JISL", "A4K", "B5 JISK", "A5L".  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
3
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Tray 7  
You can sets the display to show the type of paper loaded the tray 7  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
The paper types  
• Do not Display  
• Recycled Paper  
• Special Paper  
• Letterhead  
• Color Paper 1  
• Color Paper 2  
• Yellow  
3
• Green  
• Blue  
• Purple  
• Ivory  
• Orange  
• Pink  
• Red  
• Gray  
• OHP (Transparency)  
• Translucent Paper  
• Preprinted Paper  
• Prepunched Paper  
• Tab Stock  
• Tab Position Shift  
• Number of Tabs  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
The paper sizes  
• Metric version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "8×10L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size (when LCIT RT5000 is installed): 100.0 - 305.0 mm (verti-  
cally) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (horizontally)  
Custom Size (when LCIT RT5010 is installed): 100.0 - 330.2 mm (verti-  
cally) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (horizontally)  
3
Note  
The paper width between 100 and 139.7 mm are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L",  
"B5 JISK", "A5K", "A5L".  
• Inch version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13L",  
"8×13L", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "8×10L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "B6 JISL", "A6L"  
Custom Size (when LCIT RT5000 is installed): 3.93 - 12.00 inch (vertical-  
ly) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizontally)  
Custom Size (when LCIT RT5010 is installed): 3.93 - 13.00 inch (vertical-  
ly) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizontally)  
Note  
The paper width between 3.93 and 5.50 inch are available only when  
the special side fence is utilized.  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"81/2×11L", "81/2×51/2K", "51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L",  
"B4 JISL", "A4K", "B5 JISK", "A5L".  
Copying Method in Duplex  
• 2 Sided Copy  
1 Sided Copy  
Apply Auto Paper Select  
Yes  
• No  
Thick Paper Setting  
• On  
Off  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set designation sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
3
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Slip Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Separation Sheets  
You can specify and display the paper tray in which to set slip sheets. You  
can also specify the display time.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
Interposer Upper - Lower  
You can sets the display to show the type of paper loaded in each of the trays.  
This information is used by the print function to automatically select the pa-  
per tray.  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Items of Tray Paper Settings  
The paper sizes  
• Metric version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13K",  
"8×13K", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "8×10L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL", "8KL", "16KK", "16KL"  
Custom Size: 139.7 - 330.2 mm (vertically) and 139.7 - 458.0 mm (hori-  
zontally)  
Note  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L",  
"B5 JISK", "A5K", "A5L".  
3
• Inch version:  
"Auto Detect", "12×18L", "11×17L", "11×81/2K", "81/2×14L",  
"81/2×11L", "51/2×81/2L", "81/2×51/2K, "81/2×13L", "81/4×13K",  
"8×13K", "101/2×71/4K", "71/4×101/2L", "11×15K", "10×14L",  
"81/4×14L", "8×10L", "A3L", "B4 JISL", "A4K", "A4L", "A5K", "A5L",  
"B5 JISK", "B5 JISL"  
Custom Size: 5.50 - 13.00 inch (vertically) and 5.50 - 18.03 inch (horizon-  
tally)  
Note  
"Auto Detect" is available for "12×18L" and "11×17L", "11×81/2K",  
"81/2×11L", "81/2×51/2K", 51/2×81/2L", "8×13L", A3L",  
"B4 JISL", "A4K", "B5 JISK", "A5L".  
Designation Sheet 1 - 9  
You can specify the paper trays to set designation sheets.  
Front Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set front cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Settings  
Back Cover  
You can specify and display the paper tray to set back cover sheets. You can  
also specify the display time and copying method for two sided copying.  
• Display Time  
You can select [At Mode Selected] or [Full Time].  
• Copying Method in Duplex  
You can select [2 Sided Copy] or [1 Sided Copy].  
Copy Method in Duplex is enabled only when you select [At Mode Select-  
ed] in Display Time.  
Note  
3
When paper of the same type and size is loaded in two different paper trays  
and you want to specify tray for 2 Sided Copy. If one of the trays is specified  
as the default in Paper Tray Priority, assign 2 Sided Copy to that tray.  
A mark appears next to the paper tray if [No] is selected in [Apply Auto Paper  
Select].  
[Apply Auto Paper Select] is effective for the copier function only if [Do not Dis-  
play] or [Recycled Paper] are selected. If [No] is selected, Auto Paper Select is not  
valid for the tray.  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tray Paper Setting on Main and Sub-machines  
Tray Paper Setting on Main and Sub-machines  
This section explains the Tray Paper Setting on the two machines during Con-  
nect Copy.  
While combined copying is under way, the {User Tools} keys of the sub-ma-  
chines remain disabled. If it is desired to change the defaults, press [Combined  
Copying] that appears in reverse video on the control screen of the main machine,  
and then, clear the combined copying before making changes.  
How the defaults in the Tray Paper Settings of copying of the main and sub-ma-  
chines are used in combined copying will be explained.  
3
Paper Tray Priority: Copier (Copier/Document Server)  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Paper Tray Priority: Printer (Printer)  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Paper Type: Tray 1 (LCT)  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
Paper Type: Tray 2 - 3  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
Paper Type: Tray 4  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tray Paper Settings  
Paper Type: Tray 5  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
Paper Type: Tray 6  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
3
Paper Type: Tray 7  
• The Tray 7 on both of the main and sub-machines utilizes only for the cov-  
er sheet and the designation sheet.  
Paper Type: Interposer Upper - Lower  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• In combined copying, only the paper tray corresponding to the paper size,  
orientation, and type that are set in common on the main and sub-ma-  
chines can be used. To make the most of the combined copying function, it  
is advisable that you make the same paper settings on both the main and  
sub-machines.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Copier/Document Server  
Features  
This chapter describes various items of [Copier/Document Server Features] avail-  
able in this machine.  
General Features  
This section describes various items of [General Features] under [Copier/Document  
Server Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
For the procedure for accessing the [Copier/Document Server Features], see "Access-  
ing User Tools (System Settings)".  
Auto Image Density Priority  
You can set whether Auto Image Density is “On” or “Off” when the machine  
is turned on, reset, or modes are cleared.  
• Text  
On  
• Off  
• Text/Photo  
On  
• Off  
• Photo  
• On  
Off  
• Pale  
On  
• Off  
• General Copy  
On  
• Off  
Original Orientation in Duplex Mode  
You can set the original orientation when making two-sided copies.  
Top to Top  
• Top to Bottom  
Copy Orientation in Duplex Mode  
You can set the copy orientation when making two-sided copies.  
Top to Top  
• Top to Bottom  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copier/Document Server Features  
Reserve Job Mode  
You can set whether to reset the mode to the initial state or return to the mode  
in use before the reserved operation was started when you return to the initial  
screen after reserved copying finishes.  
• Reset  
Previous job  
Reservation Screen Auto-off Timer  
You can set the time required until the display is switched to the reserved first  
job display after reservation is set.  
If you select “Switch”, use the numbers keys to enter the time (10-99 seconds).  
The default setting is 15 seconds.  
• Yes  
No  
4
Max. Copy Quantity  
The maximum copy quantity can be set between 1 and 9999.  
The default setting is 9999 sheets.  
Original counter reset key  
You can set whether to enable the document counter reset key.  
• On  
Off  
Auto Tray Switching  
When the paper runs out during copying, it can be automatically fed from a sub-  
stitute paper feed tray, irrespective of the orientation of paper in that tray – pro-  
vided it is the same size as that set in the other paper feed tray during automatic  
paper selection. This function is called “Auto Tray Switching”. You can set  
whether to perform the Auto Tray Switching.  
With Image Rotation  
You can copy using the Auto Tray Switching function. Depending on the  
function being performed rotation may not be possible.  
• Without Image Rotation  
You can make continuous copies provided paper of the same size and ori-  
entation is loaded. The “Supply paper” message appears when paper of  
the same size and orientation runs out. Copying is interrupted when this  
happens.  
• Off  
The “Supply paper” message appears when paper runs out. Copying is in-  
terrupted when this happens.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Features  
Text  
You can adjust the edges of finished image.  
The outline of a character becomes soft when you select "Soft". The outline of  
a character can be sharply copied when you select "Sharp".  
• Copy Quality  
• Soft  
Normal  
• Sharp  
• Custom Setting  
• Image Density  
• Light  
Normal  
• Dark  
4
Text/photo  
You can select which has priority, photographs or characters, when an origi-  
nal contains both.  
If you select “Normal”, character and photo quality is balanced in the copy.  
• Copy Quality  
• Photo priority  
Normal  
• Text Priority  
• Custom Setting  
• Image Density  
• Light  
Normal  
• Dark  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Photo  
You can adjust the quality of finished images according to the type of photo original.  
“Printed photo” is set for magazine and catalog photo originals. You can  
smooth photos by selecting “Printed photo”.  
"Glossy Photo" is set for the silver-salt photos printed from photo film.  
If you select “Normal”, you can finish characters that exist together in a photo  
block.  
• Copy Quality  
• Printed photo  
Normal  
• Glossy Photo  
• Custom Setting  
• Image Density  
• Light  
4
Normal  
• Dark  
Pale  
You can adjust the image quality of a pale original so the copy is at normal density.  
• Copy Quality  
• Soft  
Normal  
• Sharp  
• Custom Setting  
• Image Density  
• Light  
Normal  
• Dark  
Generation Copy  
You can adjust the image quality to prevent characters in the copy becoming too  
thick.  
• Copy Quality  
• Soft  
Normal  
• Sharp  
• Custom Setting  
• Image Density  
• Light  
Normal  
• Dark  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Features  
Dark Background  
You can set whether "Dark Background" can be selected as an original type.  
• On  
Off  
Panel Features Default  
You can set which items will appear as the function buttons on the basic dis-  
play.  
Off  
• Reduce/Enlarge  
• Dup./Combine/Series  
• Edit Image  
• Cover/Slip Sheet  
• Stamp  
4
• Output/Customize Function/Finisher  
Image Adjustment Priority  
You can set the items, to be preferentially displayed, to the function buttons  
on the basic display.  
Off  
• Erase Inside  
• Edit Image  
Paper Display  
You can choose to have the available paper trays and sizes shown on the ini-  
tial display.  
• Hide  
Display  
Original Type Display  
You can have the original types shown on the initial display.  
• Hide  
Display  
Special Original Display  
You can set whether to show the original types on the initial display.  
• On  
Off  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Special Original Display Defaults  
You can set up to three items for displaying on the initial display from five  
items below.  
• Mixed Sizes  
• Batch  
• SADF  
• Thin Paper  
• Original Size  
Tone: Original Remains  
You can set whether to use a buzzer to alert you when you forget to remove  
an original.  
On  
4
• Off  
If the “Panel key sound” during system settings is set to “Off”, this function  
is invalidated even if it is set to “On”.  
Job End Call  
You can set whether to generate a buzzer sound (“pi”) when a copy is com-  
pleted.  
If “Panel key sound” when performing system settings is set to “On”, the  
buzzer sounds four times if copying is interrupted because the paper has run  
out or become jammed. This notifies you that the copy job could not be com-  
pleted.  
On  
• Off  
Connect Copy Key Display  
You can set whether to display the [Connect Copy]. If you select "Off", the key  
does not appear and a master unit cannot be obtained.  
On  
• Off  
Switch Original Counter Display  
You can set whether to count the two-sided documents by number of sheets  
or pages.  
Original Sheet Counter  
• Original Page Counter  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Features  
Customize Function: Copier  
A maximum of four often-used functions can be registered to the function  
keys.  
Off  
4
• Mixed Sizes  
• Batch  
• SADF  
• Thin Paper  
Customize Function: Document Server Storage  
A maximum of four often-used functions can be registered to the function  
keys. Registered functions can also be changed.  
Off  
• Mixed Sizes  
• Batch  
• SADF  
Reference  
p.43 “Panel Key Sound”  
"Selecting the Original Type Setting", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
"Adjusting Copy Image Density", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
"Selecting Copy Paper", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Reproduction Ratio  
This section describes various items of [Reproduction Ratio] under [Copier/Docu-  
ment Server Features].  
Shortcut R/E  
You can register up to two frequently used Reduce/Enlarge ratios other than  
the fixed Reduce/Enlarge ratio and have them shown on the initial display.  
You can also change registered Reduce/ Enlarge ratios.  
• Metric version  
• 25%  
• 50% (A3A5, FA5)  
• 65% (A3F)  
4
• 71% (A3A4, A4A5)  
• 75% (B4F4)  
• 82% (FA4, B4A4)  
• 93%  
• 115% (B4A3)  
• 122% (FA3, A4B4)  
• 141% (A4A3, A5A4)  
• 200% (A5A3)  
• 400%  
• User R/E Ratio (25-400%)  
• Off  
Default:  
• F1: 71%  
• F2: 141%  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Reproduction Ratio  
• Inch version  
• 25%  
• 50% (11”×17”51/2×81/2”)  
• 65% (11”×17”81/2×11”)  
• 73% (11”×15”81/2×11”)  
• 78% (81/2×14”81/2×11”)  
• 85% (F81/2×11”)  
• 93%  
• 121% (81/2×14”11”×17”)  
• 129 (%81/2×11”11”×17”)  
• 155% (81/2×81/281/2×14”)  
• 200% (51/2"×81/2"11"×17")  
• 400%  
4
• User R/E Ratio (25-400%)  
• Off  
Default:  
• F1: 73%  
• F2: 155%  
R/E Ratio  
You can specify the enlargement and reduction ratios that appear if [Re-  
duce/Enlarge] is pressed on the copier screen.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
• Metric version  
• 25%  
• 50% (A3A5, FA5)  
• 65% (A3F)  
• 71% (A3A4, A4A5)  
• 75% (B4F4)  
• 82% (FA4, B4A4)  
• 93%  
• 115% (B4A3)  
• 122% (FA3, A4B4)  
• 141% (A4A3, A5A4)  
• 200% (A5A3)  
4
• 400%  
• User R/E Ratio (25-400%)  
• Inch version  
• 25%  
• 50% (11”×17”51/2×81/2”)  
• 65% (11”×17”81/2×11”)  
• 73% (11”×15”81/2×11”)  
• 78% (81/2×14”81/2×11”)  
• 85% (F81/2×11”)  
• 93%  
• 121% (81/2×14”11”×17”)  
• 129% (81/2×11”11”×17”)  
• 155% (81/2×81/281/2×14”)  
• 200% (51/2"×81/2"11"×17")  
• 400%  
• User R/E Ratio (25-400%)  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reproduction Ratio  
R/E Ratio Priority  
You can set the ratio with priority when [Reduce / Enlarge] is pressed.  
• Metric version  
• 400%  
• 200%  
• 141%  
• 122%  
• 115%  
• 93%  
• 82%  
• 75%  
• 71%  
4
• 65%  
• 50%  
• 25%  
• Inch version  
• 400%  
• 200%  
• 155%  
• 129%  
• 121%  
• 93%  
• 85%  
• 78%  
• 73%  
• 65%  
• 50%  
• 25%  
Ratio for Create Margin  
You can set a Reduce/Enlarge ratio when registering Create Margin in a  
shortcut key.  
Enter a ratio using number keys (in the range of 90 to 99%).  
The ratio is set to 93% by default.  
Note  
For the procedure of entering the [Copier/Document Server Features], see p.3  
Reference  
p.3 “Accessing User Tools (System Settings)”  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Edit  
This section describes various items of [Edit] under [Copier/Document Server Fea-  
tures].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
Enter the width of the binding margin with the number keys as follows:  
• Metric version: 0–30 mm (in increments of 1 mm)  
• Inch version: 0"-1.2" (in increments of 0.1 inch)  
Enter the width of the erased margin with the number keys as follows:  
• Metric version: 2–99 mm (in increments of 1 mm)  
• Inch version: 0.1"-3.9" (in increments of 0.1 inch)  
4
An image of approximately 1.5 mm (0.06”) will not be displayed as the width of  
the separation line, when specifying solid or broken lines.  
Front Margin: Left/Right  
You can specify left and right margins on the front side of copies in Margin  
Adjustment mode.  
Left  
• Right  
Default:  
• Metric version: Left 5 mm  
• Inch version: Left 0.2"  
Back Margin: Left/Right  
You can specify left and right margins on the back side of copies in Margin  
Adjustment mode.  
• Left  
Right  
Default:  
• Metric version: Right 5 mm  
• Inch version: Right 0.2"  
Front Margin: Top/Bottom  
You can specify top and bottom margins on the front side of copies in Margin  
Adjustment mode.  
Top  
• Bottom  
Default:  
• Metric version: Top/Bottom 0 mm  
• Inch version: Top/Bottom 0.0"  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Edit  
Back Margin: Top / Bottom  
You can specify top and bottom margins on the back side of copies in Margin  
Adjustment mode.  
Top  
• Bottom  
Default:  
• Metric version: Top/Bottom 0 mm  
• Inch version: Top/Bottom 0.0"  
1 Sided 2 Sided Auto Margin: TtoT  
In 1 sided to 2 sided Duplex mode, you can specify the margins on the back  
side.  
The margin is set to the same value of “Back Margin: Left/Right".  
• Left  
4
Right  
Default:  
• Metric version: Right 5 mm  
• Inch version: Right 0.2"  
1 Sided 2 Sided Auto Margin: TtoB  
In 1 sided to 2 sided Duplex mode, you can specify the margins on the back  
side.  
The value set for "Back Margin: Top/Bottom" is used.  
Top  
• Bottom  
Default:  
• Metric version: Top/Bottom 0 mm  
• Inch version: Top/Bottom 0.0"  
Creep Setting for Magazine  
You can specify the creep binding margin width.  
Range:  
• Metric version: 0 to 99 mm (in increments of 1 mm)  
• Inch version: 0 to 3.9 inch (in increments of 0.1 inch)  
Default:  
• Metric version: 5 mm  
• Inch version: 0.2"  
Erase Border Width  
You can specify the width for erasing border in the range of "2 to 99 mm" (in  
units of 1 mm).  
Default:  
• Metric version: 10 mm  
• Inch version: 0.4"  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Erase Original Shadow in Combine  
In Combine mode, you can specify whether to erase a 3 mm, 0.1" boundary  
margin around all four edges of each original.  
On  
• Off  
Erase Center Width  
You can specify the width of the erased center margins with this function.  
Default:  
• Metric version: 10 mm  
• Inch version: 0.4"  
Front Cover Copy in Combine  
You can make a combined copy on the front cover sheet when you select  
Front Cover mode.  
4
GCST019E  
Combine  
• Do not Combine  
Copy Order in Combine  
You can set the copy order in Combine mode.  
From Left to Right  
• From Right to Left  
• Top to Bottom from Left  
• Top to Bttm from Right  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Edit  
Orientation: Booklet, Magazine  
You can select the orientation of copies to open when using Booklet or Mag-  
azine mode.  
Open to Left  
• Open to Right  
Copy on Designating Page in Combine  
You can specify whether to make a combined copy on the inserted slip sheets  
in Desig./Chapter mode.  
Combine  
• Don not Combine  
Image Repeat Separation Line  
You can select a separation line from: None, Solid, Broken A, Broken B, or  
Crop Marks.  
4
None  
• Solid  
• Broken A  
• Broken B  
• Crop Marks  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Double Copies Separation Line  
You can select a separation line using the Double Copies function from: None,  
Solid, Broken A, Broken B, or Crop Marks.  
None  
• Solid  
• Broken A  
• Broken B  
• Crop Marks  
4
Separation Line in Combine  
You can select a separation line using the Combine function from: None, Sol-  
id, Broken A, Broken B, or Crop Marks.  
None  
• Solid  
• Broken A  
• Broken B  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Edit  
• Crop Marks  
Copy Back Cover  
When copying the back cover, you can specify whether to have the back cover  
outside (outside page) or inside (inside page).  
Outside  
• Inside  
Double Copies Position  
You can select the copy position of bottom or left page according to top or  
right page as the original image position.  
4
Same Position as Original Image Position  
• Symmetrical to Original Image Position  
Note  
For the procedure of entering the [Copier/Document Server Features], see p.3  
Reference  
p.3 “Accessing User Tools (System Settings)”  
"Booklet/Magazine", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Stamp  
This section describes various items of [Stamp] under [Copier/Document Server Fea-  
tures].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
Background Numbering  
This section describes various items of [Background Numbering] under [Stamp].  
Size  
You can set the size of the numbers.  
• Small  
Normal  
• Large  
4
Density  
You can set the density of the numbers.  
• Light  
Normal  
• Dark  
• Very Dark  
Preset Stamp  
This section describes various items of [Preset Stamp] under [Stamp].  
Stamp Language  
You can select the language of the message printed in Stamp mode.  
English  
• German  
• French  
• Italian  
• Spanish  
• Dutch  
• Portuguese  
• Polish  
• Czech  
• Swedish  
• Finnish  
• Hungarian  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Stamp  
• Norwegian  
• Danish  
• Russian  
• Japanese  
• Simplified Chinese  
• Traditional Chinese  
• Hangul  
Stamp Priority  
You can select the stamp type given priority when [Preset Stamp] is pressed.  
COPY  
• URGENT  
4
• PRIORITY  
• For Your Info.  
• PRELIMINARY  
• For Internal Use Only  
• CONFIDENTIAL  
• DRAFT  
Stamp Format  
You can specify how each of stamp is printed.  
• Stamp Position  
You can specify where to print the stamp.  
• Top Left  
• Top Center  
Top Right  
• Center Left  
• Center  
• Center Right  
• Bottom Left  
• Bottom Center  
• Bottom Right  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
• Stamp Position  
You can adjust the print position of the stamp within the available range  
as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
4
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
Inch version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• Size  
You can set the size of the stamp.  
1X  
• 2X  
• 4X  
• Density  
You can set the pattern used to print the stamp.  
Normal  
The stamp is printed on the image. You cannot check which parts will  
overlap.  
• Lighter  
The image can be seen through the stamp.  
• Lightest  
The image appears even clearer than in the Lighter setting.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stamp  
• Page to Stamp  
You can specify whether to print the stamp on all pages or only the first  
page.  
All Pages  
• 1st Page Only  
• Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
You can adjust the stamp position for back side in duplex mode, within the  
available range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• Left-Right: Left 432 mm – Right 432 mm  
• Top-Bottom: Top 432 mm – Bottom 432 mm  
Inch version:  
• Left-Right: Left 17.0” – Right 17.0”  
4
• Top-Bottom: Top 17.0” – Bottom 17.0”  
Reference  
"Preset Stamp", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
User Stamp  
This section describes various items of [User Stamp] under [Stamp].  
Program/Delete Stamp  
You can register, change, or delete these designs as user stamps.  
You can register up to five custom stamps with your favorite designs.  
Stamp Format:1-5  
You can specify how each of registered User Stamps 1 to 5 is printed.  
• Stamp Position  
You can specify where to print the User Stamp.  
• Top Left  
• Top Center  
Top Right  
• Center Left  
• Center  
• Center Right  
• Bottom Left  
• Bottom Center  
• Bottom Right  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copier/Document Server Features  
• Stamp Position  
You can adjust the print position of the User Stamp within the available  
range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
4
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
Inch version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• Page to Stamp  
You can specify whether to print the stamp on all pages or only the first  
page.  
• All Pages  
1st Page Only  
• Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
You can adjust the stamp position for back side in duplex mode, within the  
available range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• Left-Right: Left 432 mm – Right 432 mm  
• Top-Bottom: Top 432 mm – Bottom 432 mm  
Inch version:  
• Left-Right: Left 17.0” – Right 17.0”  
• Top-Bottom: Top 17.0” – Bottom 17.0”  
Reference  
Copy/ Document Server Reference"User Stamp"  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stamp  
Date Stamp  
This section describes various items of [Date Stamp] under [Stamp].  
Format  
You can select the date format for Date Stamp mode.  
• MM/DD/YYYY  
• MM.DD.YYYY  
• DD/MM/YYYY  
• DD.MM.YYYY  
• YYYY.MM.DD  
Default:  
4
• Metric version: DD/MM/YYYY  
• Inch version: MM/DD/YYYY  
Font  
You can select the Date Stamp font.  
Font 1  
• Font 2  
• Font 3  
Size  
You can set the Date Stamp size.  
Auto  
• Large  
• Middle  
• Small  
Superimpose  
You can have the Date Stamp printed in white when it overlaps black parts of  
the image.  
• On  
Off  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copier/Document Server Features  
Stamp Setting  
You can specify how Date Stamp is printed.  
• Stamp Position  
You can specify where to print the Date Stamp.  
Top Left  
• Top Center  
• Top Right  
• Bottom Left  
• Bottom Center  
• Bottom Right  
• Stamp Position  
You can adjust the print position of the Date Stamp within the available  
range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
4
• "Top Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
Inch version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• Page to Stamp  
You can specify whether to print the stamp on all pages or only the first  
page.  
All Pages  
• 1st Page Only  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stamp  
• Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
You can adjust the stamp position for back side in duplex mode, within the  
available range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• Left-Right: Left 432 mm – Right 432 mm  
• Top-Bottom: Top 432 mm – Bottom 432 mm  
Inch version:  
• Left-Right: Left 17.0” – Right 17.0”  
• Top-Bottom: Top 17.0” – Bottom 17.0”  
Page Numbering  
This section describes various items of [Page Numbering] under [Stamp].  
4
Stamp Format  
You can select the page number format given priority when [Page Numbering]  
is pressed.  
P1,P2…  
• 1/5,2/5…  
• -1-,-2-…  
• P.1,P.2…  
• 1,2…  
• 1-1,1-2…  
Font  
You can select the font in Page Numbering mode.  
Font 1  
• Font 2  
• Font 3  
Size  
You can set the size of the stamp printed in Page Numbering mode.  
Auto  
• Large  
• Middle  
• Small  
Duplex Back Page Stamping Position  
You can set the position of the duplex back page number printed in Duplex  
mode.  
Opposite Position  
• Same Position  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copier/Document Server Features  
Page Numbering in Combine  
You can set page numbering when using the Combine function and the Page  
Numbering function together.  
Per Original  
• Per Copy  
Stamp on Designating Slip Sheet  
You can select to print the page number onto slip sheets when using the Des-  
ignate function set to [Copy] and the Page Numbering function together.  
• On  
Off  
Stamp Position  
You can specify how each of stamp is printed.  
4
• Stamp Position  
You can specify where to print the stamp.  
• Top Left  
• Top Center  
• Top Right  
• Bottom Left  
• Bottom Center  
• Bottom Right  
For the patterns of "P1, P2, ---", "1/5, 2/5, ---", "P.1, P.2, ---", "1, 2, --", and "Page  
1, Page 2, ---", the machine is shipped from the factory with this position set  
to "Top Right".  
For the patterns of "-1-, -2-, ---" and "1-1, 1-2, --- ", the machine has this position  
set to "Bottom Center".  
The setting range is as follows:  
• Stamp Position  
You can adjust the print position of the stamp within the available range  
as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stamp  
Inch version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
You can adjust the stamp position for back side in duplex mode, within the  
available range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
4
• Left-Right: Left 432 mm – Right 432 mm  
• Top-Bottom: Top 432 mm – Bottom 432 mm  
Inch version:  
• Left-Right: Left 17.0” – Right 17.0”  
• Top-Bottom: Top 17.0” – Bottom 17.0”  
Superimpose  
You can have page numbers printed in white when they overlap black parts  
of the image.  
• On  
Off  
Page Numbering Initial Letter  
Switch the page print language.  
P1, P2, ... / P.1, P.2 ...  
• S1, S2, ... / S.1, S.2 ...  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Stamp Text  
This section describes various items of [Stamp Text] under [Stamp].  
Font  
You can select the font in Stamp Text mode.  
Font 1  
• Font 2  
• Font 3  
Size  
You can set the size of the stamp printed in Stamp Text mode.  
Auto  
4
• Large  
• Middle  
• Small  
Superimpose  
You can have the Stamp Text printed in white when it overlaps black parts of  
the image.  
• On  
Off  
Stamp Setting  
You can specify how Stamp Text is printed.  
• Stamp Position  
You can specify where to print the Stamp Text.  
• Top Left  
• Top Center  
Top Right  
• Bottom Left  
• Center Right  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Stamp  
• Stamp Position  
You can adjust the print position of the Stamp Text within the available  
range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Center"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 72-72mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 72-72mm  
4
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 4-144mm, L/R: 4-144mm  
Inch version:  
• "Top Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Top Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Top Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center Left"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Center"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Center Right"…T/B: 2.8-2.8”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Left"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• "Bottom Center"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 2.8-2.8”  
• "Bottom Right"…T/B: 0.1-5.7”, L/R: 0.1-5.7”  
• Page to Stamp  
You can specify whether to print the stamp on all pages or only the first  
page.  
All Pages  
• 1st Page Only  
• Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
You can adjust the stamp position for back side in duplex mode, within the  
available range as shown below.  
Metric version:  
• Left-Right: Left 432 mm – Right 432 mm  
• Top-Bottom: Top 432 mm – Bottom 432 mm  
Inch version:  
• Left-Right: Left 17.0” – Right 17.0”  
• Top-Bottom: Top 17.0” – Bottom 17.0”  
Note  
For the procedure of entering the [Copier/Document Server Features], see p.3  
“Accessing User Tools (System Settings)”  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Input/Output  
This section describes various items of [Input/Output] under [Copier/Document Serv-  
er Features].  
SADF Auto Reset  
In SADF mode, an original must be set within a specified time after the pre-  
vious original has been fed.  
You can adjust this time from 3 to 99 seconds in increments of 1 second.  
The timing is set to "5 second(s)" by default.  
Copy Eject Face Method in Glass Mode  
You can specify the way in which copies are delivered when copying an orig-  
inal placed on the exposure glass.  
4
Face Up  
• Face Down  
Memory Full Auto Scan Restart  
When memory becomes full while scanning originals, the machine can make  
copies of scanned originals first, and then automatically proceed scanning re-  
maining originals.  
• On  
You can leave the machine unattended to make copies, but sorted pages  
will not be sequential.  
Off  
When memory becomes full, the machine stops operation allowing you to  
remove the copy pages delivered on the output tray.  
Sort/Stack Shift setting  
You can specify whethere to shift the Shift Tray in sort mode or stack mode.  
On  
• Off  
Insert Separation Sheet  
You can specify the number of copy pages for inserting the Separation Sheet  
from 1 to 999 pages in increments of 1 page.  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Input/Output  
Staple Position  
Specify which Top 2 staples or Bottom shown on the initial display with pri-  
ority.  
The optional Finisher AFE, or the Booklet Processor is required to use this  
function.  
• Top 1  
• Slant  
• Left 2  
• Top 2  
• Bottom 1  
• Top Right 1  
• Right 2  
• Off  
4
Punch Type  
Specify which punch type (2 holes or 3 holes) has priority to be shown on the  
initial display.  
The optional Finisher AFE and Multi-hole Punch Unit is required to use this  
function.  
• Left 2  
• Top 2  
• Right 2  
• Left 3  
• Top 3  
• Right 3  
• Off  
Finisher: Staple Position  
Specify the stapling position.  
The optional Finisher AFE, or the Booklet Processor is required to use this  
function.  
• Top 1  
• Slant  
• Left 2  
• Top 2  
• Bottom 1  
• Center  
• Top Right 1  
• Right 2  
• Off  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Finisher: Punch Type  
Specify the punch type.  
The optional Finisher AFE and Multi-hole Punch Unit are required to use this  
function.  
• Left 2  
• Top 2  
• Right 2  
• Left 3  
• Top 3  
• Right 3  
• Off  
Simplified Screen: Finishing Types  
You can select which key is displayed with higher priority for “Finishing  
Types” on the Simplified Screen.  
4
• Stack  
• Slant  
• Top 1  
• Bottom 1  
• Left 2  
• 2 Holes Left  
• 3 Holes Left  
• Do not Display  
Reference  
"Orientation-Fixed Paper or Two-Sided Paper", Troubleshooting  
"Batch mode", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
"Sort", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings for the Document Server  
Settings for the Document Server  
For details, see "System Settings", and "Copier/Document Server Features".  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Heading  
items  
Default  
General Features  
Document Server Storage key  
2 Sided original:  
Top to Top  
General Features  
General Features  
General Features  
Document Server Storage key  
Document Server Storage key  
Document Server Storage key  
1 Sided 1 Sided  
Combine: 2 origi-  
nals  
1 Sided 1 Sided  
Combine: 4 origi-  
nals  
4
1 Sided 1 Sided  
Combine: 8 origi-  
nals  
General Features  
General Features  
Document Server Storage key  
Document Server Storage key  
Create Margin  
Original Orienta-  
tion  
System Settings  
Heading  
Item  
Default  
On  
General Features  
General Features  
General Features  
Warm Up Notice  
Copy Count Display  
Output: Document Server  
Up  
Finisher Upper  
Tray  
General Features  
Paper Tray Priority: Copier  
Tray 1  
Off  
Tray Paper Settings Cover Sheet Tray  
Tray Paper Settings Slip Sheet Tray  
Off  
Timer Settings  
Copier/Document Server Auto Reset Timer  
60 second(s)  
3 day(s)  
Administrator  
Tools  
Auto Delete File in Document Server  
Administrator  
Tools  
Delete All Files in Document Server  
-
p.113 “Copier/Document Server Features”  
p.43 “System Settings”  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copier/Document Server Features  
Copier/Document Server Features on  
Main and Sub-machines  
This section explains the Copier/Document Server Features on the two ma-  
chines during Connect Copy.  
While combined copying is under way, the {User Tools} keys of the sub-ma-  
chines remain disabled. If it is desired to change the defaults, press [Combined  
Copying] that appears in reverse video on the control screen of the main machine,  
and then, clear the combined copying before making changes.  
General Features  
4
How the defaults in the General Features of copying of the main and sub-ma-  
chines are used in combined copying will be explained.  
Auto Image Density Priority  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
• The paper size, orientation, and paper type currently set in common on the  
main and sub-machines are selected automatically.  
Original Orientation in Duplex Mode  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Copy Orientation in Duplex Mode  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Reserve Job Mode  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Reservation Screen Auto-off Timer  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Max. Copy Quantity  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Original Counter Reset Key  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copier/Document Server Features on Main and Sub-machines  
Auto Tray Switching  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
Text  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Text/Photo  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Photo  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
4
Pale  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Generation Copy  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Dark Background  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Panel Features Default  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Image Adjustment Priority  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Paper Display  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Original Type Display  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Special Original Display  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Special Original Display Default  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Tone: Original Remains  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Job End Call  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
• When [On] is selected, only the main machine beeper sounds.  
Switch Original Counter Display  
• The main and sub-machines follow their respective set values.  
4
Customize Function: Copier  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Customize Function: Document Server Storage  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Reproduction Ratio  
How the defaults in the Reproduction Ratio of copying of the main and sub-ma-  
chines are used in combined copying will be explained.  
Shortcut R/E  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
R/E Ratio  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
R/E Ratio Priority  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Ratio for Create Margin  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copier/Document Server Features on Main and Sub-machines  
Edit  
How the defaults in the Edit of copying of the main and sub-machines are used  
in combined copying will be explained.  
Front Margin: Left/Right  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Back Margin: Left/Right  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
4
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Front Margin: Top/Bottom  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Back Margin: Top/Bottom  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
1 Sided 2 Sided Auto Margin: TtoT  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
1 Sided 2 Sided Auto Margin: TtoB  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Creep Setting for Magazine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copier/Document Server Features  
Erase Border Width  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Erase Original Shadow in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Erase Center Width  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
4
Front Cover Copy in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Copy Order in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Orientation: Booklet, Magazine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Copy on Designating Page in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Image Repeat Separation Line  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Double Copies Separation Line  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features on Main and Sub-machines  
Separation Line in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Copy Back Cover  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• The operation takes place using the set values of the main machine.  
Double Copies Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
4
Stamp  
How the defaults in the Stamp of copying of the main and sub-machines are  
used in combined copying will be explained.  
Background Numbering  
Size  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Density  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Preset Stamp  
Stamp Language  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp Priority  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copier/Document Server Features  
Stamp Format  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Dup. Back Pg. Stanp Pos.  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
User Stamp  
Program/Delete Stamp  
4
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp Format:1-5  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Dup. Back Pg. Stanp Pos.  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Date Stamp  
Format  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Font  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Size  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features on Main and Sub-machines  
Superimpose  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp Setting  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
4
Page Numbering  
Stamp Format  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Font  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Size  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Duplex Back Page Stamping Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Page Numbering in Combine  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp on Designating Slip Sheet  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features  
Stamp Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Superimpose  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
4
Stamp Text  
Font  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Size  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Superimpose  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp Setting  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Page to Stamp  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stamp Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copier/Document Server Features on Main and Sub-machines  
Dup. Back Pg. Stamp Pos.  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Input/Output  
How the defaults in the Stamp of copying of the main and sub-machines are  
used in combined copying will be explained.  
SADF Auto Reset  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
4
Copy Eject Face Method in Glass Mode  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
Memory Full Auto Scan Restart  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
• Main machine settings have priority.  
Sort/Stack Shift setting  
The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The set values of the  
sub-machines do not affect the combined copying.  
Insert Separation Sheet  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Stapling Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Select Punch Type  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Finisher: Staple Position  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copier/Document Server Features  
Finisher: Punch Type  
• The main machine follows the values that are set in it. The sub-machines  
follows the settings made on the main machine, regardless of the settings  
made in it.  
Simplified Screen: Finishing Types  
• The set values of the main and sub-machines do not affect the combined  
copying.  
• When the main machine is set to the simplified screen, you can not utilize  
the combined copying.  
4
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Printer Features  
This chapter explains various items of [Printer Features] available in this machine.  
List / Test Print  
This section describes various items of [List / Test Print] under [Printer Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
For the procedure for accessing the [Printer Features], see "Accessing User Tools  
(System Settings)".  
Multiple Lists  
You can print the configuration page and error log.  
Configuration Page  
You can print the machine's current configuration values.  
Error Log  
You can print error logs listing all errors that occurred during printing. The  
most recent 50 errors are stored in the error log. If a new error is added when  
there are 50 errors already stored, the oldest error is deleted. However, if the  
oldest error belongs to one of the following print jobs, it is not deleted. The  
error is stored separately until the number of those errors reaches 30. You can  
check any of these print jobs for error log information.  
• Sample Print  
• Locked Print  
• Hold Print  
• Stored Print  
The records of Auto Job Cancel and jobs canceled manually from the control  
panel can be printed.  
Menu List  
You can print a Menu List showing the machine's function menus.  
PCL Configuration/Font Page  
You can print the current configuration and installed PCL font list.  
PS Configuration/Font Page  
You can print the current configuration and installed PostScript font list.  
This menu can be selected only when the optional PostScript 3 unit is in-  
stalled.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printer Features  
PDF Configuration/Font Page  
You can print the current configuration and installed PDF font list.  
This menu can be selected only when the optional PostScript 3 unit is in-  
stalled.  
Hex Dump  
You can print in the Hex Dump mode.  
Printing the configuration page  
A Press [Printer Features].  
B Press [Configuration Page]] on the [List / Test Print].  
5
The configuration page is printed.  
C Press the {User Tools} key.  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
List / Test Print  
Interpreting the configuration page  
System Reference  
• Unit Number  
Displays the serial number assigned to the board by its manufacturer.  
• Total Memory  
Displays the total amount of memory (SDRAM) installed on the printer.  
• Firmware Version  
• Printer  
Displays the version number of the printer firmware.  
• System  
Displays the version number of the system firmware.  
• Engine  
Displays the version number of the printer engine.  
• LCDC  
5
Displays the version number of the panel display.  
• NIB  
Displays the version number of the Network interface.  
• Device Connection  
This item(s) appears when the device option(s) is installed.  
• HDD: Font / Macro Download  
Displays the capacity of the hard disk drive.  
• Printer Language  
Displays the version number of the printer driver language.  
• Connection Equipment  
Displays the installed optional equipments.  
Paper Input  
Displays settings made under Tray Paper Settings menu.  
System  
Displays settings made under the System menu.  
PCL Menu  
Displays settings made under PCL Menu.  
PS Menu  
Displays settings made under PS Menu.  
PDF Menu  
Displays settings made under PDF Menu.  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printer Features  
Host Interface  
Displays settings made under the Host Interface menu.  
When DHCP is active on the network, the actual IP address, subnet mask and  
gateway address appear in parentheses on the configuration page.  
Interface Information  
Displays the interface information.  
5
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Maintenance  
This section describes various items of [Maintenance] under [Printer Features]  
List / Test Print Lock  
You can Lock the [List/Test Print] menu.  
• On  
Off  
Delete All Temporary Print Jobs  
You can delete all print jobs temporarily stored in the machine.  
Delete All Stored Print Jobs  
Reference  
p.43 “System Settings”  
5
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printer Features  
System  
This section describes various items of [System] under [Printer Features].  
Print Error Report  
Select this to have an error report printed when a printer or memory error oc-  
curs.  
• On  
Off  
Auto Continue  
You can select this to enable Auto Continue. When it is On, printing continues  
after a system error occurs.  
Off  
• Immediate  
• 1 minute  
• 5 minutes  
• 10 minutes  
• 15 minutes  
5
Memory Overflow  
Select this to have a memory overflow error report printed.  
Do not Print  
• Error Information  
Job Separation  
You can enable Job Separation.  
This menu can be selected only when a finisher (optional) is installed.  
• On  
Off  
Auto Delete Temporary Print Jobs  
You can select to automatically delete print jobs temporarily stored in the ma-  
chine.  
• On  
Off: 8 hours  
If you select [on], you can set up to 200 hours for auto file deleting.  
Auto Delete Stored Print Jobs  
You can select to automatically delete print jobs stored in the machine.  
On: 3 days  
If you select [on], you can set up to 180 days for auto file deleting.  
• Off  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
System  
Initial Print Job List  
You can set the desired type of print job list that appears on the screen when  
you press [Print Jobs].  
Complete List  
Displays the list of print jobs stored in the machine.  
• List Per User ID  
Displays the list of the User ID who stored a file in the machine.  
Memory Usage  
You can select the amount of memory used in Font Priority or Frame Priority,  
according to paper size or resolution.  
• Font Priority  
This setting uses memory for registering fonts.  
Frame Priority  
This setting uses frame memory for high speed printing.  
Duplex  
5
You can select to have print on both sides of each pages.  
Off  
• Long Edge Bind  
• Short Edge Bind  
Copies  
You can specify the number of print sets. This setting is disabled if the num-  
ber of pages to print has been specified with the printer driver or another  
command.  
• 1–9999  
Default: 1  
Blank Page Print  
You can select whether or not to print blank pages.  
On  
• Off  
Pages that match one of the following conditions are identified as blank.  
• There are no images.  
• There are images but they are outside of the printable area.  
• There are only blank characters.  
Toner Saving  
Select either to apply or not to apply Toner Saving.  
• On  
Off  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printer Features  
Spool Image  
You can select to print spool images. The print job transmitted from the com-  
puter is temporarily stored on the machine's hard disk as bit map images that  
can be printed when transmission is complete. If more than one print job is  
transmitted, a spool image is printed for each.  
Off  
• On  
Reserved Job Waiting Time  
You can specify how long the machine waits to receive a print job before al-  
lowing other functions such as the copier and scanner functions to interrupt  
it.  
• Long Wait  
• Medium Wait  
Short Wait  
• In Reserved Job Order  
5
Printer Language  
You can specify the printer language.  
Auto  
• PCL  
• PS  
• PDF  
This menu appears only when the PostScript 3 unit (optional) is installed.  
Sub Paper Size  
You can enable the Auto Substitute Paper Size (A4.LT) feature.  
• Auto  
Off  
Page Size  
You can select the default paper size.  
• 12×18  
• 11×17  
• 81/2×14  
• 81/2×11  
• 51/2×81/2  
• 71/4×101/2  
• 8×13  
• 81/2×13  
• 81/4×13  
• A3  
• B4 JIS  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
System  
• A4  
• B5 JIS  
• A5  
• B6 JIS  
• A6  
• 8K  
• 16K  
• Custom Size  
Default:  
• Metric version: A4  
• Inch version: 81/2×11  
Letterhead Setting  
You can rotate original images when printing.  
When printing, original images are always rotated by 180 degrees. Therefore,  
output might not be as expected when printing onto letterhead or preprinted  
paper requiring orientation. Using this function, you can specify image rota-  
tion.  
5
Off  
When set to Off, original images are rotated by 180 degrees.  
• Auto Detect  
When set to Auto Detect, the machine detects a letterhead or preprinted  
paper automatically, and does not rotate them.  
• On (Always)  
When set to On (Always), the machine does not rotate the original images.  
This function reduces printing speed.  
Bypass Tray Setting Priority  
You can specify which of the two options, (Printer) Driver / Command or  
Machine Settings, has priority for determining the paper size for the bypass  
tray.  
Driver / Command  
• Machine Settings  
Edge to Edge Print  
You can select whether or not to print on the entire sheet.  
• On  
Off  
The 5 mm margin along the edges may not be printed properly.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printer Features  
Default Printer Language  
You can set the default printer language if the machine cannot find the printer  
language automatically.  
PCL  
• PS  
• PDF  
This menu appears only when the PostScript 3 unit (optional) is installed.  
Tray Switching  
You can set to switch the paper tray.  
Off  
• On  
Reference  
"Loading paper", Troubleshooting  
5
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Host Interface  
Host Interface  
This section describes various items of [Host Interface] under [Printer Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
I/O Buffer  
You can set the size of the I/O Buffer. Normally it is not necessary to change  
this setting.  
128KB  
• 256KB  
I/O Timeout  
You can set how many seconds the machine should wait before ending a print  
job. If data from another port usually arrives in the middle of a print job, you  
should increase this timeout period.  
• 10 seconds  
15 seconds  
• 20 seconds  
• 25 seconds  
• 60 seconds  
5
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printer Features  
PCL Menu  
This section describes various items of [PCL Menu] under [Printer Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
Orientation  
You can set the page orientation.  
Portrait  
• Landscape  
Form Lines  
You can set the number of lines per page.  
• 5 to 128 by 1  
Default:  
• Metric version: 64  
• Inch version: 60  
5
Font Source  
You can set the storage location of the default font.  
Resident  
• RAM  
• HDD  
• SD  
RAM, HDD and SD can be selected only when fonts have been downloaded  
to the machine.  
Font Number  
You can set the ID of the default font you want to use.  
• 0 to 63 by 1  
The ID is set to "0" by default.  
Point Size  
You can set the point size you want to use for the selected font.  
• 4.00 to 999.75 by 0.25  
This setting is effective only with variable-space fonts.  
The size is set to "12.00" by default.  
Font Pitch  
You can set the number of characters per inch for the selected font.  
• 0.44 to 99.99 by 0.01  
This setting is effective only with fixed-space fonts.  
The font pitch is set to "10.00" by default.  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PCL Menu  
Symbol Set  
You can specify the set of print characters for the selected font. The available  
options are as follows:  
Roman-8, ISO L1, ISO L2, ISO L5, PC-8, PC-8 D/N, PC-850, PC-852, PC8-TK,  
Win L1, Win L2, Win L5, Desktop, PS Text, VN Intl, VN US, MS Publ, Math-8,  
PS Math, VN Math, Pifont, Legal, ISO 4, ISO 6, ISO 11, ISO 15, ISO 17, ISO 21,  
ISO 60, ISO 69, Win 3.0  
Courier Font  
You can select a courier font type.  
Regular  
• Dark  
Extend A4 Width  
You can extend the printing area width (when printing on A4 sheet with  
PCL).  
Off  
5
• On  
When the setting is On, the width will be 81/2 inches.  
Append CR to LF  
When set to On, a carriage return will follow each line feed: CR=CR, LF=CRLF,  
FF=CRFF.  
Off  
• On  
Resolution  
You can set the print resolution in dots per inch.  
• 300 dpi  
600 dpi  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printer Features  
PS Menu  
This section describes various items of [PS Menu] under [Printer Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
This menu appears only when the optional PostScript 3 unit is installed.  
Data Format  
You can select a data format.  
• Binary Data  
TBCP  
This setting is not effective when operating the machine with a parallel or  
EtherTalk connection.  
When operating the machine with a parallel connection, and also if the binary  
data is sent from the printer driver, the print job is canceled.  
When operating the machine with an Ethernet connection, the print job is can-  
celed under the following conditions;  
5
• The printer driver data format is TBCP, and the data format selected on the  
display panel is Binary Data.  
• The printer driver data format is binary, and the data format selected on  
the display panel is TBCP.  
Resolution  
You can set the print resolution in dots per inch.  
• 300 dpi  
600 dpi  
• 1200 dpi  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PDF Menu  
PDF Menu  
This section describes various items of [PDF Menu] under [Printer Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
Change PDF Password  
Set the password for the PDF file executing PDF Direct Print.  
• Current Password  
• New Password  
• Confirm New Password  
A password can be set using on the Web Image Monitor, but in this case the  
password information is sent through the network. If security is a priority, set  
the password using this menu from the Control Panel.  
PDF Group Password  
Set the group password already specified with DeskTopBinder Lite.  
5
• Current Password  
• New Password  
• Confirm New Password  
A password can be set using on the Web Image Monitor, but in this case the  
password information is sent through the network. If security is a priority, set  
the password using this menu from the Control Panel.  
Resolution  
You can set the print resolution in dots per inch.  
• 300 dpi  
600 dpi  
• 1200 dpi  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printer Features  
5
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Scanner Features  
This chapter describes various items of [Scanner Features] available in this ma-  
chine.  
General Settings  
Following describes various items of [General Settings] under [Scanner Features].  
Default settings are shown in bold type.  
For the procedure for accessing the [Scanner Features], see "Accessing User Tools  
(System Settings)".  
Switch Title  
Sets index to use when the list of receivers from the machine is displayed.  
Update Delivery Server Destination List  
Press [Update Delivery Server Destination List] to update the receivers from the  
delivery server. To use this function, it is necessary to set [Delivery Option] to  
[On].  
Search Destination  
Select an object receiver to search in the default state from the address book  
of this machine of from LDAP server.  
To search from LDAP server, it is necessary to register the LDAP server in  
[System Settings] and set [LDAP Search] to [On].  
TWAIN Standby Time  
When the machine is being used to send e-mail or a file, or functioning as  
Document Server or a network delivery scanner, a scanning request to the  
machine as a TWAIN scanner will switch the machine to the network TWAIN  
scanner function. This setting determines the delay until the machine switch-  
es to the network TWAIN scanner function.  
• Immediate  
When [Immediate] is selected, the machine will switch to the network  
TWAIN scanner function at once.  
• Set Time: 10 second(s)  
When [Set Time] is selected, you can enter the delay time with the number  
keys (3-30 seconds). The machine will switch to the network TWAIN scan-  
ner function when the time set here passes after the last key operation.  
Destination List Display Priority 1  
Select a destination list to be displayed when the machine is in the initial state.  
You can select either [E-mail / Folder] or [Delivery Server].  
• E-mail / Folder  
Delivery Server  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanner Features  
Destination List Display Priority 2  
In the machine’s address book, select which address book appears by default.  
You can select either [E-mail Address] or [Folder].  
E-mail Address  
• Folder  
Print & Delete Scanner Journal  
Up to 100 transmission/delivery results can be checked on this machine. If  
the stored transmission/delivery results reach 100, select whether to print the  
delivery journal.  
On  
The transmission/delivery journal is printed automatically. The printed  
journal is deleted.  
• Off  
Transmission/delivery results are deleted one by one as new results are  
stored.  
• Do not Print: Disable Send  
Transmission/delivery cannot be performed when the journal is full.  
When printed, all records are deleted after printing. When not printed,  
records over the limit are automatically deleted in succession from the oldest  
record.  
6
While the journal is being printed, files with the status waiting cannot be sent.  
Print Scanner Journal  
The scanner journal is printed and deleted.  
Delete Scanner Journal  
The scanner journal is deleted without being printed.  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan Settings  
Scan Settings  
Following describes various items of [Scan Settings] under [Scanner Features].  
A.C.S. Sensitivity Level  
Sets the sensitivity level for judging color/black and white for scanning orig-  
inals when [Scan Type] is set to [Auto Color Selection].  
Wait Time for Next Orig.: Exposure Glass  
When dividing originals and scanning them individually with the exposure  
glass to form a single file, select [Continuous Wait], [Off], or [Set Wait Time] for the  
waiting status.  
• Continuous Wait  
• Off  
Set Wait Time: 60 second(s)  
If you select [SADF] in [Original Feed Type] on the Scan to Folder screen, the [Wait  
Time for Next Orig.: Exposure Glass] setting becomes invalid.  
If you select [Batch] in [Original Feed Type] on the Scan to Folder screen, the  
[Wait Time for Next Orig.: Exposure Glass] setting becomes invalid, and the ma-  
chine waits for an additional original to be put in place.  
6
If [Set Wait Time] is selected, enter the wait time in seconds (3-999) for placing  
additional originals with the number keys. Scanning will start if additional  
originals are placed and the {Start} key is pressed within this time. You can  
end scanning and begin transmission by pressing the {#} key within this time.  
Once the specified time has elapsed, transmission starts automatically.  
If [Continuous Wait] is selected, the machine will wait for additional originals  
until the {#} key is pressed. Scanning will start when additional originals are  
placed and the {Start} key is pressed. You can end scanning and begin send-  
ing by pressing the {#} key.  
If originals are placed in the auto document feeder (ADF), transmission will  
start without waiting for additional originals after all originals in the ADF  
have been scanned, regardless of the specified settings.  
If a paper misfeed occurs or any of the following operations is performed  
while the machine is waiting for additional originals, the countdown stops  
and does not start again until the {#} key is pressed.  
• Changing the settings such as the scan settings  
• Opening the upper cover of the ADF  
• Pressing the {Interrupt} key to activate the copy mode  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanner Features  
Wait Time for Next Original(s): SADF  
When dividing originals and scanning them separately with the ADF to form  
a single file, select [Set Wait Time] or [Continuous Wait] for the waiting status.  
• Continuous Wait  
Set Wait Time: 60 second(s)  
This setting is valid if [SADF] is specified for [Original Feed Type] when scan-  
ning.  
If [Set Wait Time] is selected, enter the wait time in seconds (3-999) for placing  
additional originals with the number keys. Scanning will start automatically  
if additional originals are placed within this time. You can end scanning and  
begin transmission by pressing the {#} key within this time. Once the speci-  
fied time has elapsed, transmission starts automatically.  
If [Continuous Wait] is selected, the machine will wait for the additional origi-  
nals until the {#} key is pressed. Scanning will start when additional originals  
are placed and the {Start} key is pressed. You can end scanning and begin  
sending by pressing the {#} key.  
Even if originals are placed on the exposure glass, the machine will operate  
according to the specified settings. However, every time originals are placed  
on the exposure glass, you must press the {Start} key to start scanning. Scan-  
ning will start if additional originals are placed and the {Start} key is pressed  
within this time. You can end scanning and begin transmission by pressing  
the {#} key within this time. Once the specified time has elapsed, transmis-  
sion starts automatically.  
6
If originals are placed in the auto document feeder (ADF), transmission will  
start without waiting for additional originals after all originals in the ADF  
have been scanned, regardless of the specified settings.  
If a paper misfeed occurs or any of the following operations is performed  
while the machine is waiting for additional originals, the countdown stops  
and does not start again until the {#} key is pressed.  
• Changing the settings such as the scan settings  
• Opening the upper cover of the ADF  
• Pressing the {Interrupt} key to activate the copy mode  
Background Density of ADS (Full Color)  
Characteristics due to the type of paper such as non-whiteness like newspaper  
or transparent originals can be reduced by correcting the scanning density.  
Reference  
"Batch, SADF", Scanner Reference  
"Items for Specifying Scan Settings", Scanner Reference  
"Setting Items for Original Feed Type", Scanner Reference  
"Scanning Multiple Pages of Originals as One File", Scanner Reference  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Send Settings  
Send Settings  
This section describes various items of [Send Settings] under [Scanner Features].  
Compression (Black & White)  
Select whether or not to compress black and white scan files.  
On  
• Off  
Compression reduces the time required for transferring the scan file.  
The actual time required for file transfer will vary depending on the file size  
and network load.  
Compression (Gray Scale / Full Color)  
Specify whether or not to compress multi level (gray scale) scan files.  
On: Compression Level 3  
• Off  
If you select [On], you can specify the compression level between one and five.  
The image quality is better for lower compression, but the time required for  
file transfer increases accordingly.  
The actual time required for file transfer will vary depending on the file size  
and network load.  
6
High Compression PDF Level  
Select compression level when creating high compression PDF files.  
• Higher  
Standard  
Max. E-mail Size  
Select whether or not to limit the size of an e-mail to which an image is at-  
tached.  
On: 2048KB  
• Off  
When [On] is selected, enter the size limit (128-102400 KB) with the number  
keys.  
When the SMTP limits the size, match that setting.  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanner Features  
Divide & Send E-mail  
This function is effective only when [On] is selected for [Max. E-mail Size].  
Select whether or not an image exceeding the size specified in [Max. E-mail Size]  
should be divided and sent using more than one e-mail.  
Yes (per Max. Size): 5  
• Yes (per Page)  
• No  
When [Yes (per Max. Size)] is selected, enter the Max. Number of Divisions (2-  
500) with the number keys.  
When [Multi-page: TIFF] or [Multipage: PDF] is selected for [File Type Priority], the  
image will not be divided even if [Yes (per Page)] is selected.  
When [Yes (per Max. Size)] is selected, some received files may not be able to be  
restored, depending on the type of e-mail software.  
When [No] is selected, the e-mail is not sent if its size exceeds the limit, and an  
error message appears. The scan file is discarded.  
Set the maximum e-mail size within the capacity of the SMTP server.  
E-mail Information Language  
Select the language in which e-mail information such as title, document  
name, and sender's name is sent.  
Select one of the following 20 languages:  
6
British English, American English, German, French, Italian, Spanish, Dutch,  
Portuguese, Polish, Czech, Swedish, Finnish, Hungarian, Norwegian, Dan-  
ish, Japanese, Simplified Chinese, Traditional Chinese, Russian, and Hangul.  
Default:  
• Metric version: British English  
• Inch version: American English  
The e-mail text which is a template cannot be changed.  
No. of Digits for Single Page Files  
Sets digit number for serial number to attach to Single Page file name.  
4 Digits  
• 8 Digits  
Stored File E-mail Method  
Specify the e-mail setting for sending stored files. You can select [Send File] or  
[Send URL Link]. This setting can be used for the following:  
Send File  
• Send URL Link  
If you select [Send File], actual files are attached to e-mails.  
If you select [Send URL Link], URL Links to file locations are attached to e-mails.  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Registering Addresses and  
Users for Scanner Functions  
Following describes the procedure for registering the destination and the user.  
Address Book  
Registering information such as the names of users and their e-mail addresses in  
the Address Book allows you to manage them easily.  
Important  
Address Book data is stored on the hard disk. It can be lost if there is some  
kind of hard disk failure. The manufacturer shall not be responsible for any  
damages resulting data loss.  
You can register and manage the following items in the Address Book:  
Names  
You can register the name of the user and the key display. This is the basic in-  
formation required for managing user of the machine.  
To register a e-mail address in the address book, you must register informa-  
tion such as the user name and destination name in advance.  
Auth. Info  
You can register user codes in order to restrict particular functions to certain  
users, and to check their use of each function. You can also register login user  
names and login passwords to be used when sending e-mail, sending to fold-  
ers, or accessing an LDAP server.  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Protection  
You can set protection codes to stop sender's name from being used or folders  
from being accessed without authorization.  
E-mail  
You can register e-mail destinations in the Address Book.  
7
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Address Book  
Folder  
You can register the protocol, path name and server name.  
• SMB  
• FTP  
• NCP  
7
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Add to Group  
You can put registered e-mail and folder destinations into a group for easier  
management.  
Note  
You can also use a Web Image Monitor to register names in the Address Book.  
With the SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, you can register multiple names at  
the same time.  
Using [Address Management Tool] in SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin, you can  
backup Address Book data. We recommend backing up data when using the  
Address Book.  
For details about using Web Image Monitor, see the Web Image Monitor Help.  
For operating instructions, see SmartDeviceMonitor for Admin Help.  
7
Managing names in the Address Book  
By registering a name and key display beforehand, you can specify e-mail and  
Reference  
p.184 “Registering Names”  
Sending e-mail by Quick Dial  
You can also specify an e-mail address by selecting the destination shown on the  
initial scanner display when sending a document using the scanner function. A  
registered e-mail address can be used as the sender's address, and the sender's  
address are automatically entered in the “From" field of an mail header.  
Reference  
p.196 “E-mail Destination”  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Address Book  
Sending scanned files to a shared folder directly  
After registering the path name, user name and password, you can connect to a  
shared folder simply by selecting the destination shown on the initial scanner  
display whenever sending files using the scanner function to a shared folder.  
To share the folder using Windows, select the SMB protocol.  
To register the folder to the FTP server, select the FTP protocol.  
Reference  
p.200 “Registering Folders”  
Preventing unauthorized user access to shared folders from the machine  
After registering a protection code, you can specify the object of protection to  
prevent an e-mail destination from being used without permission.  
Reference  
p.228 “Registering a Protection Code”  
Managing users and machine usage  
7
Register user codes to limit users to the following functions and check their use  
of each function:  
• Copier  
• Document Server  
• Scanner  
• Printer  
Reference  
p.187 “Authentication Information”  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Registering Names  
Register user information including their names.  
The user name is useful for selecting a destination when sending e-mail. You can  
also use it as a folder destination.  
You can register up to 2000 names.  
Registering Names  
Following describes the procedure for registering names.  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Press [New Program].  
F Press [Change] on the right of the Name.  
The name entry display appears.  
G Enter the name, and then press [OK].  
H Press the key for the classification you want to use under Select Title.  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Registering Names  
I Press [OK] twice.  
J Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
The name can be used for documents in the Document Server. For details  
about the Document Server.  
The keys you can select are as follows:  
[Freq.]: Added to the page that is displayed first.  
[AB], [CD], [EF], [GH], [IJK], [LMN], [OPQ], [RST], [UVW], [XYZ], [1] to [10]:  
Added to the list of items in the selected title.  
You can select [Freq.] and one more page for each title.  
Reference  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
"Document Server", Copy/ Document Server Reference  
Changing a Registered Name  
This section describes the procedure for changing a name.  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the registered name you want to change.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
F To change the name or key display, press [Change] on the right of the name  
or key display.  
G Enter the name or key display, and then press [OK].  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
H To change the title, press the key for the classification you want to use from  
Select Title.  
Note  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail  
address.  
Reference  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
To change a registration number  
A Press [Change] to the right of “Registration No.”  
B {E#n}tekreayn. ew registration number using the number keys, and then press the  
Deleting a Registered Name  
Following describes the procedure for deleting a user.  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Select the name you want to delete.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
F Press [Yes].  
G Press [Exit].  
H Press the {User Tools} key.  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Authentication Information  
Authentication Information  
Following describes the procedure for authenticating a user code.  
Important  
The functions associated with each user code are the same. If you change or  
delete user codes, management data and limits associated with that code be-  
come invalid.  
Register user codes to limit users to the following functions and check their use  
of each function:  
Copier  
Document Server  
Scanner  
Printer  
Note  
You can register up to 500 user codes.  
The number of copies scanned using the scanner function is counted for each  
user code. This allows you to check each user's usage.  
To automatically register the printer driver user code, select [Printer: PC Con-  
trol] for the printer in User Code Authentication. To use the user code set in  
User Tools, set the user codes registered in User Tools for the printer driver.  
7
Reference  
p.73 “User Authentication Management”  
Registering a User Code  
Following describes the procedure for registering a user code.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Press the name whose code is to be registered, or enter the registered num-  
ber using the number key.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info].  
G Enter the user code using the number keys, and then press {#} key.  
If you make a mistake, press [Clear] or the {Clear/Stop} key.  
H Press [TNext] twice.  
I Select the functions to be used with the user code from Available Functions.  
7
J Press [OK].  
K Press [Exit].  
L Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
User codes can contain up to eight digits.  
Reference  
p.184 “Registering Names”  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Authentication Information  
Changing a User Code  
Following describes the procedure for changing a registered user code.  
Important  
Even if you change a user code, the counter value will not be cleared.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
7
E Select the user whose user code you want to change.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info].  
G Press [Change], and then enter the new user code using the number keys  
H Press {#} key.  
I To change the available functions, press [Auth. Info] and then press [TNext]  
twice.  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
J Press the key to select the functions to enable them.  
Press the key to highlight it, and then the function is enabled. To cancel a se-  
lection, press the highlighted key.  
K Press [OK].  
L Press [Exit].  
M Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
Reference  
p.185 “Changing a Registered Name”  
Deleting a User Code  
Following describes the procedure for deleting a user code  
Important  
After clearing the user code, the counter is automatically cleared.  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Press [Program/Change].  
E Select the name whose code is to be deleted.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info].  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Authentication Information  
G Press [Change] to delete the user code, and then press {#} key.  
H Press [OK].  
I Press [Exit].  
J Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
To delete a name from the Address Book entirely, see “Deleting a Regis-  
tered Name”.  
Reference  
p.186 “Deleting a Registered Name”  
7
Displaying the Counter for Each User  
Following describes the procedure for displaying the counter on individual user  
basis.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Display/Clear/Print Counter per User].  
D Select the function usage you want to print from [Copier Counter], [Print  
Counter] or [Scanner Counter].  
Counters for individual function usage under each user code appear.  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Printing the Counter for Each User  
Following describes the procedure for printing the counter that counts on indi-  
vidual user basis.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Display/Clear/Print Counter per User].  
D Select a user code from the left side of the display.  
7
Press [Select All on the Page] to select all user codes on the page.  
E Press [Print Counter List] under Per User.  
Enter the user code, and then press {#} if the user code is registered.  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Authentication Information  
F Select the function usage you want to print from [Copier Counter], [Print  
Counter], and [Scanner Counter].  
G Press [Print].  
Printing the Counter for All User  
Following describes the procedure for printing the counter for all users.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Display/Clear/Print Counter per User].  
D Press [Print Counter List] under All Users.  
7
Enter the user code, and then press {#} if the user code is registered.  
E Select the function usage you want to print from [Copier Counter], [Print  
Counter], [Scanner Counter] and [All Counters].  
F Press [Print].  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Clearing the Number of Prints  
Following describes the procedure for clearing the counter.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Display/Clear/Print Counter per User].  
D Select the user code to clear.  
E To clear the number of prints made under a user code, Select the user code  
from the left side of the display.  
7
Press [Select All on the Page] to select all user codes on the page.  
F Press [Clear] under Per User Codes.  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Authentication Information  
G Select the function usage you want to clear from [Copier Counter], [Print  
Counter], [Scanner Counter] and [All Counters].  
H Press [OK].  
I To clear the number of prints for all user codes, press [Clear] under All Users.  
J Select the function usage you want to clear from [Copier Counter], [Print  
Counter], and [Scanner Counter].  
K Press [OK].  
7
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
E-mail Destination  
Register e-mail destinations so you do not need to enter an e-mail address every  
time, and can send scan files from scanner function by e-mail.  
• It is easy to select the e-mail destination if you register “Name" and “Key Dis-  
play" as the e-mail destination.  
• You can register e-mail destinations as a group.  
• You can use the e-mail address as the sender's address when sending scan  
files in scanner mode. If you want to do this, set a protection code on the send-  
er address to prevent unauthorized access.  
Note  
You can select an e-mail address from an LDAP server, and then register it in  
Reference  
p.228 “Registering a Protection Code”  
Registering an E-mail Destination  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose e-mail address you want to register. Press the name  
key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
F Press [E-mail].  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
E-mail Destination  
G Press [Change].  
H Enter the e-mail address.  
7
I Press [OK].  
J Select [E-mail].  
K Press [OK].  
Note  
You can enter up to 128 characters for the e-mail address.  
p.187 “Registering a User Code”  
p.219 “Registering Names to a Group”  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Changing an E-mail Destination  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose e-mail address you want to change.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [E-mail].  
G Press [Change] under E-mail Address.  
H Enter the e-mail address, and then press [OK].  
I Press [OK].  
Note  
Reference  
p.185 “Changing a Registered Name”  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
E-mail Destination  
Using the e-mail address as the sender  
A Press [Protection].  
B Press [Sender ] under [Use Name as].  
Deleting an E-mail Destination  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
7
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose e-mail address you want to delete.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [E-mail].  
G Press [Change] under E-mail Address.  
H Press [Delete All].  
I Press [OK] twice.  
J Press the {User Tools} key.  
Note  
To delete the name, key display, and title, see “Deleting a Registered Name”.  
Reference  
p.186 “Deleting a Registered Name”  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Registering Folders  
By registering a shared folder, you can send scan files to it directly.  
There are three types of protocol you can use:  
• SMB  
For sending files to shared Windows folders.  
• FTP  
Use when sending files to an FTP server.  
• NCP  
Use when sending files to an Net- Ware server.  
Note  
For details about protocols, server names, and folder levels, consult your net-  
work administrator.  
You can prevent unauthorized users from accessing folders from the ma-  
chine. See "Registering a Protection Code".  
You can only select either SMB, FTP, or NCP. If you change protocol after fin-  
ishing your settings, all previous entries are cleared.  
You can register folder destinations in a group.  
Using SMB to Connect  
7
Note  
To register a folder in an FTP server, see “Using FTP to Connect”.  
To register a folder in an NetWare server, see “Using NCP to Connect”.  
p.207 “Using FTP to Connect”  
p.212 “Using NCP to Connect”  
Registering a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Registering Folders  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose folder you want to register. Press the name key, or  
enter the registered number using the number keys.  
F Press [Auth. Info], and then press [Next].  
G Press [Specify Other Auth. Info] on the right side of Folder Authentication.  
H Press [Change] under Login User Name.  
I Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
J Press [Change] under Login Password.  
K Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
L Enter the password again to confirm, and then press [OK].  
M Press [Folder].  
7
N Press [SMB].  
O Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
P Press [Exit].  
Q Press [OK].  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
R Press [Exit].  
Note  
To register the name, see Registering Names”.  
You can enter a path using up to 128 characters.  
To specify a folder, you can either enter the path manually or locate the  
folder by browsing the network.  
If the connection test fails, check the settings, and then try again.  
When Do not Specify is selected, the SMB User Name and SMB Password  
that you have specified in Default User Name / Password (Send) of File  
Transfer settings applies.  
p.202 “To locate the folder manually”  
p.203 “Using Browse Network to locate the folder”  
To locate the folder manually  
A Press [Change] under Path.  
B Enter the path where the folder is located.  
C Press [OK].  
7
If the format of the entered path is not correct, a message appears. Press [Exit],  
and then enter the path again.  
Note  
Enter the path using the format as follows : ”\\ServerName\ShareName\Path-  
Name”  
You can also enter an IPv4 address.  
You can enter a path using up to 128 characters.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Folders  
Using Browse Network to locate the folder  
A Press [Browse Network].  
Work groups on the same network are displayed.  
Network display only lists client computers you are authorized to access.  
B Select the work group.  
Computers in the selected work group are displayed.  
C Select a client computer.  
Shared folders under it appear.  
You can press [Up One Level] to switch between levels.  
D Select the folder you want to register.  
E [OK].  
7
If a Login Screen Appears  
This section explains how to log on to the machine if the login screen appears  
when you try to access a folder by browsing the network.  
If you have not specified folder authentication, or if an incorrect user name or  
password has been entered for folder authentication, the login screen appears.  
A Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
Enter the login user name specified for folder authentication.  
B Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
The path to the selected folder appears.  
If a message appears, press [Exit], and then enter the login user name and  
password again.  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Changing a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose folder you want to change.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [Folder].  
G Select the items you want to change.  
When specifying a folder, enter the path directly or select it by referencing the  
network. For more information, see "To locate the folder manually" and "Us-  
ing Browse Network to locate the folder".  
H Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
I Press [OK].  
J Press [Exit].  
Note  
Reference  
p.185 “Changing a Registered Name”  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Folders  
To change the protocol  
A Press [FTP] or [NCP].  
B A confirmation message appears. Press [Yes].  
Changing the protocol will clear all settings made under the previous protocol.  
Reference  
p.207 “Registering a Folder”  
Changing SMB settings  
7
To change SMB settings:  
A Press [Change] of path name.  
B Enter the name of the path on which the folder is located, and then press  
[OK].  
Note  
Reference  
p.203 “Using Browse Network to locate the folder”  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Deleting a registered folder  
A [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Select the name whose folder you want to delete.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [ Folder].  
G Press the protocol which is not currently selected.  
A confirmation message appears.  
H Press [Yes].  
I Press [OK].  
J Press [Exit].  
Note  
To delete the name, key display, and title, see “Deleting a Registered Name”.  
Reference  
p.186 “Deleting a Registered Name”  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Folders  
Using FTP to Connect  
Note  
To register a shared folder configured in Windows, see “Using SMB to Connect”.  
To register a folder in an NetWare server, see “Using NCP to Connect”.  
p.200 “Using SMB to Connect”  
p.212 “Using NCP to Connect”  
Registering a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose folder you want to register.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info], and then press [Next].  
G Press [Specify Other Auth. Info] on the right side of Folder Authentication.  
H Press [Change] under Login User Name.  
I Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
J Press [Change] under Login Password.  
K Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
L Enter the password again to confirm, and then press [OK].  
M Press [Folder].  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
N Press [FTP].  
O A confirmation message appears. Press [Yes].  
P Press [Change] under Server Name.  
Q Enter the server name, and then press [OK].  
R Press [Change] under Path.  
S Enter the path.  
T Press [OK].  
U Press [Change] under “Port Number”.  
V Enter Port Number.  
7
W Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
X Press [Exit].  
Y Press [OK].  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Folders  
Z Press [Exit].  
Note  
To register the name, see Registering Names”.  
You can enter up to 128 characters for the user name.  
You can enter up to 128 characters for the password.  
You can enter a server name using up to 64 characters.  
You can enter an absolute path, using this format: “/user/ home/user-  
name"; or a relative path, using this format: “directory/sub-directory".  
If you leave the path blank, the login directory is assumed to be the current  
working directory.  
You can also enter an IPv4 address.  
You can enter a path using up to 128 characters.  
To change the port number, press [Change] under Port No.. Enter the port  
number using the number keys, and then press {#}.  
Specify the port number within the range of 1 to 65535.  
If the connection test fails, check the settings, and then try again.  
When [Do not Specify] is selected, the FTP User Name and FTP Password  
that you have specified in Default User Name / Password (Send) of File  
Transfer settings applies. For details, see "File Transfer".  
7
p.202 “To locate the folder manually”  
p.203 “Using Browse Network to locate the folder”  
Changing a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
209  
 
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose folder you want to change, and then press [Folder].  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Folder].  
G Select the items you want to change.  
H Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
I Press [OK].  
J Press [Exit].  
Note  
Reference  
p.185 “Changing a Registered Name”  
To change the protocol  
A Press [SMB], or [NCP].  
7
B A confirmation message appears.Press [Yes].  
Changing the protocol will clear all settings made under the previous protocol.  
Reference  
p.200 “Registering a Folder”  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Folders  
Changing items under FTP  
A Press [Change] under “Port Number”.  
B Enter the new port number, and then press {#}.  
C Press [Change] under Server Name.  
D Enter the new server name, and then press [OK].  
E Press [Change] under “Path”.  
F Enter the new path, and then press [OK].  
Deleting a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose folder you want to delete.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Folder].  
G Press the protocol which is not currently selected.  
A confirmation message appears.  
H Press [Yes].  
I Press [OK].  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
J Press [Exit].  
Note  
Reference  
p.186 “Deleting a Registered Name”  
Using NCP to Connect  
Note  
To register a shared folder configured in Windows, see “Using SMB to Con-  
nect”  
p.200 “Using SMB to Connect”  
p.207 “Using FTP to Connect”  
Registering a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Press the name you want to register or enter the registered number using  
the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info], and then press [Next].  
G Press [Specify Other Auth. Info] on the right side of Folder Authentication.  
H Press [Change] under Login User Name.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Folders  
I Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
J Press [Change] under Login Password.  
K Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
L Enter the password again to confirm, and then press [OK].  
M Press [Folder].  
N Press [NCP].  
O A confirmation message appeares. Press [Yes].  
P Select "Connection Type".  
If you want to specify a folder in an NDS tree, press [NDS]. If you want to spec-  
ify a folder on a NetWare server, press [Bindery].  
Q Specify the folder.  
R Press [OK].  
S Press [Exit].  
Note  
To register the name, see Registering Names”.  
7
You can enter up to 64 characters for the user name.  
If you have set "Connection Type" to [NDS], enter the user name followed  
by the name of the context where the user object is located. If the user name  
is “user" and the context name is “context", enter “user.context"  
You can enter up to 64 characters for the password.  
To specify a folder, you can either enter the path manually or locate the  
folder by browsing the network.  
When [Do not Specify] is selected, the NCP User Name and NCP Password  
that you have specified in Default User Name / Password (Send) of File  
Transfer settings applies. For details, see "File Transfer".  
p.214 “To locate the folder manually”  
p.214 “Using Browse Network to locate the folder”  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
To locate the folder manually  
A Press [Change] under Path.  
B Enter the path where the folder is located.  
C [OK].  
D Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
E Press [Exit].  
Note  
If you set "Connection Type" to [NDS], and if the NDS tree name is "tree",  
the name of the context including the volume is "context", the volume  
name is "volume" and the folder name is "folder", then the path will be  
"\\tree\volume. context\folder".  
If you set "Connection Type" to [Bindery], and if the Net-Ware server name  
is "server", the volume name is "volume" and the folder name is "folder",  
then the path will be "\\server\volume\folder".  
You can enter a path using up to 128 characters.  
If the connection test fails, check the settings, and then try again.  
Using Browse Network to locate the folder  
7
A Press [Browse Network].  
B If you have set "Connection Type" to [NDS], a list of items in the NDS tree  
appears. If you have set "Connection Type" to [Bindery], a list of items on the  
NetWare server appears.  
C Search for the destination folder in the NDS tree or NetWare server.  
You can press [Up One Level] to switch between levels.  
D Select the folder you want to register.  
E [OK].  
Note  
Only the folders you are allowed to access appear in [Browse Network].  
If the languages used on the machine and the destination you want to view  
differ, the items in the list may not appear correctly.  
Up to 100 items can be displayed in the list.  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Folders  
Changing a registered folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the user of the registered folder you want to change.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [Folder].  
G Select "Connection Type".  
If you want to specify a folder in an NDS tree, press [NDS]. If you want to spec-  
ify a folder on a NetWare server, press [Bindery].  
H Specify the folder.  
To specify a folder, you can either enter the path manually or locate the folder  
by browsing the network.  
I Press [Connection Test] to check the path is set correctly.  
J Press [OK].  
K Press [Exit].  
Note  
Reference  
p.185 “Changing a Registered Name”  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Changing NCP settings  
To change NCP settings:  
A Select the type of connection.  
B Press [Change] of path name.  
C Enter the name of the path on which the folder is located, and then press  
[OK].  
D Press [Connection Test] to make sure the path is correctly set up.  
E When you have made the necessary changes to the information, press [Set].  
F Press [Close].  
Note  
To specify a folder, enter its path directly or select it using Browser Net-  
work.  
p.214 “To locate the folder manually”  
p.214 “Using Browse Network to locate the folder”  
7
To change the protocol  
A Press [SMB], or [FTP].  
B A confirmation message appears. Press [Yes].  
Changing the protocol will clear all settings made under the previous protocol.  
p.200 “Registering a Folder”  
p.207 “Registering a Folder”  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Folders  
Deleting a Folder  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Proglam/Change] is selected.  
E Select a user of the folder you want to delete.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [Folder].  
G Press the protocol which is not currently selected.  
A confirmation message appears.  
H Press [Yes].  
I Press [OK].  
J [Exit].  
Note  
Reference  
p.186 “Deleting a Registered Name”  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Registering Names to a Group  
You can register names to a group to enable easy management of e-mail address-  
es and folders for each group.  
To add names to a group, the groups must be registered beforehand.  
Important  
When using Scan to Folder function, you cannot send scan files to a group  
with over 50 folders registered.  
The maximum number of destinations registerable to a group is 500.  
Note  
You can set a protection code to prevent unauthorized access to the folders  
Reference  
p.228 “Registering a Protection Code”  
Registering a Group  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program/Change/Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program/Change] is selected.  
E Press [New Program].  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Names to a Group  
F Press [Change] under Group Name.  
G Enter the group name, and then press [OK].  
The Key Display name is set automatically.  
H Press the title key under Select Title, if necessary.  
I When you want to change the key display, press [Change] under Key Dis-  
play. Enter the key display, and then press [OK].  
J Press [OK].  
Note  
The keys you can select are as follows:  
[Freq.]: Added to the page that is displayed first.  
7
[AB], [CD], [EF], [GH], [IJK], [LMN], [OPQ], [RST], [UVW], [XYZ], [1] to [10]…  
Added to the list of items in the selected title.  
You can select [Freq.] and one more page for each title.  
Reference  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
Registering Names to a Group  
You can put names that have been registered in the Address Book into a group.  
When registering new names, you can also register groups at the same time.  
A Press [System Settings].  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the name to register in a group.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Add to Group].  
G Select a group to which you want to add the name to.  
The group key that you have selected becomes highlighted, and the name is  
added to it.  
7
H Press [OK].  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Names to a Group  
Adding a Groupe to Another Group  
You can add a group to another group.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the group that you want to put into another group.  
Press the group key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
F Press [Add to Group].  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
G Select the group which you want to add to.  
The group key that you have selected becomes highlighted, and the group is  
added to it.  
7
H Press [OK].  
Displaying Names Registered in a Group  
You can check the names or groups registered in each group.  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Names to a Group  
E Select the group where the members you want to check is egistered.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Programmed User/Group].  
All the names registered will be displayed.  
G Press [OK].  
Removing a Name from a Group  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
7
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the name to remove from a group.  
Press the name key, or enter the registered number using the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Add to Group].  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
G Select the group from which you want to remove the name.  
The group key is deselected, and the name is removed from the group.  
H Press [OK].  
7
Deleting a Group Within Another Group  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is seleced.  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Names to a Group  
E Select the group that you want to delete from.  
Press the group key, or enter the registered number during the number keys.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Add to Group].  
The keys of groups in which the group is registered appear highlighted.  
G Select the group that you want to delete from.  
The group key is deselected and the group is deleted from it.  
7
H Press [OK].  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Changing a Group Name  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Press the group key you want to change.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F To change the group name and key display, press [Change] under Group  
7
Name or Key Display.  
G Enter the new group name or key display, and then press [OK].  
H To change the title, press the title key under Select Title.  
I To change the registration number, press [Change] under Registration No..  
J Enter the new registration number using the number keys.  
K Press the {#} key.  
L Press [OK].  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Names to a Group  
Deleting a Goup  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Press [Delete].  
E Press [Yes].  
F Press a group key you want to delete.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
7
G Press [Yes].  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Registering a Protection Code  
You can stop sender's names or folders being accessed by setting a protection code.  
You can use this function to protect the following:  
• Folders  
You can prevent unauthorized access to folders.  
• Sender's names  
Reference  
p.187 “Registering a User Code”  
Registering a Protection Code to a Single User  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Select the name whose protection code you want to register.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Registering a Protection Code  
F Press [Protection].  
G Press [Destination] or [Sender] under Use Name as.  
Both [Destination] and [Sender] can be selected at the same time.  
7
H Press [Change] under Protection Code.  
I Enter a protection code using the number keys, and then press {#}.  
J Press [OK].  
K Press [Exit].  
Note  
You can specify a protection code of up to eight digits. You can also specify  
“Protection” without specifying a protection code.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
Registering a Protection Code to a Group User  
A Press [System Settings].  
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book: Program / Change / Delete Group].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Press the group key you want to register or enter the registered number us-  
ing the number keys.  
F Press [Protection].  
7
G Press [Folder Destination] under Protection Object.  
H Press [Change] under Protection Code.  
I Enter a protection code using the number keys, and then press the {#} key.  
J Press [OK].  
K Press [Exit].  
Note  
You can specify a protection code of up to eight digits. You can also specify  
“Protection” without specifying a protection code.  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Registering SMTP and LDAP Authentication  
Registering SMTP and LDAP Authentication  
SMTP Authentication  
For each user registered in the Address Book, you can register a login user name  
and login password to be used when accessing an SMTP server.  
To use an SMTP server, you need to program it beforehand.  
Important  
When [Do not Specify] is selected for SMTP Authentication, the User Name  
and Password that you have specified in SMTP Authentication of File Trans-  
fer settings applies. For details, see "File Transfer".  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
E Press the name you want to register or enter the registered number using  
the number keys  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
F Press [Auth. Info].  
G Press [Specify Other Auth. Info] on the right side of SMTP Authentication.  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
H Press [Change] under Login User Name.  
I Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
J Press [Change] under Login Password.  
K Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
L Enter the password again to confirm, and then press [OK].  
M [OK].  
Note  
To register the name, see Registering Names”.  
You can enter up to 191 characters for the user name.  
7
When using POP before SMTP Authentication, you can enter up to 63 al-  
phanumeric characters.  
You can enter up to 64 characters for the password.  
To change the SMTP Authentication settings, repeat step to .  
B
M
p.184 “Registering Names”  
p.15 “Network Settings”  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Registering SMTP and LDAP Authentication  
LDAP Authentication  
For each user registered in the Address Book, you can register a login user name  
and login password to be used when accessing an LDAP server.  
To use an LDAP server, you need to program it beforehand. For details, see  
“LDAP Server Settings", Network Guide.  
Important  
When [Do not Specify] is selected for LDAP Authentication, the User Name  
and Password that you have specified in Program/Change LDAP Server of  
Administrator Tools settings applies. For details, see "LDAP Server Settings".  
If there is user authentication in place, check with the administrator.  
A Press [System Settings].  
7
B Press [Administrator Tools].  
C Press [Address Book Management].  
D Check that [Program / Change] is selected.  
You can search by the registered name, user code, folder name, or e-mail address.  
E Press the name you want to register or enter the registered number using  
the number keys.  
F Press [Auth. Info], and then press [Next].  
G Press [Specify Other Auth. Info] on the right side of LDAP Authentication.  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Registering Addresses and Users for Scanner Functions  
H Press [Change] under Login User Name.  
I Enter the login user name, and then press [OK].  
J Press [Change] under Login Password.  
K Enter the password, and then press [OK].  
L Enter the password again to confirm, and then press [OK].  
M Press [OK].  
Note  
To register the name, see Registering Names”.  
When [Do not Specify] is selected for LDAP Authentication, the User Name  
and Password that you have specified in Program/Change LDAP Server  
of Administrator Tools settings applies.  
7
You can enter up to 128 characters for the user name.  
To change the LDAP Authentication settings, repeat step to .  
B
M
Reference  
p.184 “Registering Names”  
"Entering Text", About This Machine  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
8. Other User Tools  
Initial settings allow you switch the language as well as checking the number of  
printed papers by displaying the counter.  
Changing the Display Language  
You can change the language used on the display. English is set as default.  
A Press the {Language Selection} key.  
APD015S  
Note  
If you want to return the display language to “English”, repeat the step  
above.  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Other User Tools  
Inquiry  
The Inquiry function lets you check the telephone numbers to contact for repairs,  
or ordering consumables such as toner. Be sure to contact your service engineer  
to verify the following:  
Consumables  
• Telephone No. to order  
• Toner  
• Staple  
• Staple (Center)  
Machine Maintenance/Repair  
• Telephone No.  
• Serial No. of Machine  
Sales Representative  
• Telephone No.  
A Press [Inquiry].  
8
Inquiry information appears.  
B Press [Print Inquiry List].  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Inquiry  
C Press the {Start} key.  
The inquiry information list is printed out.  
D Press [Exit] twice.  
8
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other User Tools  
Counter  
Displaying the Total Counter  
You can display the total counter value used for all functions.  
You can also print out a counter data list.  
A Press {Counter} key.  
APD016S  
B To print a counter list, press [Print Counter List].  
8
C Press the {Start} key.  
A counter list prints out.  
D Press [Exit] twice.  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Counter  
Method of Counting  
The counter increments “1” for each original sheets. In duplex mode, it counts  
“2” for front and back of original sheet.  
The counter increments at the functions below:  
• Copying  
• Printing  
• Scanning  
• Test Print (Multiple Lists, Configuration Page, Error Log, Menu List, PCL  
Configuration/Font Page, PS Configuration/Font Page, PDF Configura-  
tion/Font Page, Hex Dump)  
• Printing Destination List of Address Book  
The counter does not count at the functions below:  
• Printing Counter List  
• Printing Error Report  
• Printing in SP Mode  
• Printing Inquiry List  
• Printing Interface Settings Configuration List  
• Cover sheet and Designation sheet, Slip sheet, Separation sheet, without  
printing  
8
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Other User Tools  
8
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Appendix  
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
Changing the Adjustment Settings for Operators  
A Press the {User Tools} key.  
APD014S  
B Press [Adjustment Settings for Operators].  
C Select the item that you want to change the value.  
D Specify the setting value.  
To select the setting value, press the value on the display.  
To input the value, use the number keys.  
E Press {enter}.  
F Press [Exit] twice.  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix  
Setting Values  
Feed  
Shift Image With Feed  
1-710-001 : Front Side  
• Max.: 2 mm  
• Min.: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-710-002 : Back Side  
• Max.: 2 mm  
• Min.: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-710-003 : Front Side (Low Speed Mode)  
• Max.: 2 mm  
• Min.: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-710-004 : Back Side (Low Speed Mode)  
• Max.: 2 mm  
9
• Min.: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
Shift Image Across Feed  
1-720-001 : Tray 1  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
1-720-002 : Tray 2  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-720-003 : Tray 3  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-720-004 : Tray 4 LCT  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-720-005 : Tray 5 LCT  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-720-006 : Tray 6 LCT  
• Max: 2 mm  
9
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0  
1-720-007 : Tray 7 Bypass  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial: value 0  
1-720-008 : Duplex  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min:-2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial: value 0  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Set Fusing Temparature  
1–740–001 : Set Fusing Temparature  
• 1: Raise temperature to improve fusing  
• 2: Lower temperature to reduce curl  
Double-Feed Detection  
1-908-001 : Tray 1  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-002 : Tray 2  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-003 : Tray 3  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-004 : Tray 4 (LCT Tray 1)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-005 : Tray 5 (LCT Tray 2)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-006 : Tray 6 (LCT Tray 3)  
9
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-007 : Tray 7 (Bypass Tray)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-908-008 : After Double-Feed Detection  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
CIS Img Pos Adj: Feed Setting  
1-911-001 : Tray 1  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-002 : Tray 2  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-003 : Tray 3  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-004 : Tray 4 (LCT Tray 1)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-005 : Tray 5 (LCT Tray 2)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-006 : Tray 6 (LCT Tray 3)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
1-911-007 : Tray 7 (Bypass Tray)  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
9
1-911-008 : Duplex Tray  
• 0: Off  
• 1: On  
Drum  
Magnification Adjustment Across Feed  
2-750-001 : Copy Image: Front Side  
• Max: 0.3 %  
• Min: -0.3 %  
• Step: 0.1 %  
• Initial value: 0 %  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
2-750-002 : Copy Image: Back Side  
• Max: 0.3 %  
• Min: -0.3 %  
• Step: 0.1 %  
• Initial value: 0 %  
2-750-003 : Print Image: Front Side  
• Max: 0.3 %  
• Min: -0.3 %  
• Step: 0.1 %  
• Initial value: 0 %  
2-750-004 : Print Image: Back Side  
• Max: 0.3 %  
• Min: -0.3 %  
• Step: 0.1 %  
• Initial value: 0 %  
Magnification Adjustment With Feed  
2–760–001 : Magnification Adjustment With Feed  
• Max: 0.3 %  
• Min: -0.3 %  
• Step: 0.1 %  
• Initial value: 0 %  
Temp / Humidity Display  
9
2-770-001 : Internal Temperature  
• Max: 60 °C  
• Min: -20 °C  
• Step: 1 °C  
• Initial value: –  
2-770-002 : Internal Humidity  
• Max: 100 %  
• Min: 0 %  
• Step: 1 %  
• Initial value: –  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
Process  
Select Test Pattern  
3–740–001 : Select Test Pattern  
• Trim Pattern  
Reset to Defaults  
3–740–002 : Reset to Defaults  
Peripherals  
Staple Position Adjustment  
6-700-001 : A3-Lengthwise  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-002 : B4 SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
9
6-700-003 : A4 SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-004 : A4 LEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
6-700-005 : B5 SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-006 : B5 LEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.1 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-007 : DLT SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-008 : LG SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-009 : LT SEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
9
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-010 : LT LEF  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-700-011 : Other  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
Adjust Punch Hole : With Feed  
6-705-001 : 2-Hole: JPN  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-705-002 : 3-Hole: NA  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-705-003 : 4-Hole: Europe  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-705-004 : 4-Hole: NA  
• Max: 2 mm  
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-705-005 : 2-Hole: NA  
• Max: 2 mm  
9
• Min: -2 mm  
• Step: 0.5 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
Adjust Booklet Stapling Position  
6-730-001 : A3 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
6-730-002 : B4 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-003 : A4 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-004 : B5 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-005 : 12 x 18 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-006 : DLT SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
9
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-007 : LG SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-730-008 : LT SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjustment Settings for Operators  
6-730-009 : Custom Size  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
Adjust Booklet Fold Position  
6-735-001 : A3 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-002 : B4 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-003 : A4 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-004 : B5 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
9
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-005 : 12 x 18 SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
6-735-006 : DLT  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-007 : LG  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-008 : LT SEF  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
6-735-009 : Custom Size  
• Max: 3.0 mm  
• Min: -3.0 mm  
• Step: 0.2 mm  
• Initial value: 0 mm  
9
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications for the Main Unit  
Specifications for the Main Unit  
Configuration:  
Console  
Photosensitivity type:  
OPC drum (100)  
Original scanning:  
One-dimensional solid scanning system through CCD  
Copy process:  
Dry electrostatic transfer system  
Development:  
Dry two-component magnetic brush development system  
Fusing:  
Heating roll pressure system  
Resolution:  
1200 dpi  
Exposure glass:  
Stationary original exposure type  
Original reference position:  
Rear left corner  
Warm-up time:  
Less than 300 seconds (23°C)  
9
Originals:  
Sheet/Book/Objects  
Original size:  
A3L - A5KL, 11" × 17"L - 51/2" × 81/2" KL  
Copy paper size:  
13" × 18" – Postcard (depending on the paper trays)  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
Copy paper weight:  
• Tray 1 - Tray 3 : 52 - 216 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover  
• Tray 4, Tray 5 (LCIT RT5000), Tray 4 - Tray 6 (LCIT RT5010) : 52 - 216 g/m2,  
16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover, 110 lb. Index  
• Tray 6 (LCIT RT5000): 52 - 163 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond - 60 lb. Cover  
• Tray 7 (Multi Bypass Tray BY5000): 52 - 216 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover,  
p.264 “LCIT RT5000”  
p.265 “LCIT RT5010”  
Non-reproduction area:  
• Leading edge: More than 4 ± 2 mm  
• Trailing edge: More than 2 + 2/1.7 mm  
• Left edge: More than 2 ± 1.5 mm  
• Right edge: More than 2 ± 1.5 mm  
First copy time:  
• Type 1  
• 3.5 seconds (for Face Up)  
• 5 seconds (for Face Down)  
• Type 2  
• 3.2 seconds (for Face Up)  
• 4.5 seconds (for Face Down)  
• Type 3  
• 3 seconds (for Face Up)  
• 4 seconds (for Face Down)  
9
Copying speed:  
• Type 1  
• 90 copies/minute (A4 K, 81/2" × 11"K)  
• Type 2  
• 110 copies/minute (A4 K, 81/2" × 11"K)  
• Type 3  
• 135 copies/minute (A4 K, 81/2" × 11"K)  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications for the Main Unit  
Reproduction ratio:  
Preset reproduction ratios:  
• Enlargement  
Metric version: 400 %, 200 %, 141 %, 122 %, 115 %  
Inch version: 400 %, 200 %, 155 %, 129 %, 121 %  
• Full Size  
Metric version: 100 %  
Inch version: 100 %  
• Reduction  
Metric version: 93 %, 82 %, 75 %, 71 %, 65 %, 50 %, 25 %  
Inch version: 93 %, 85 %, 78 %, 73 %, 65 %, 50 %, 25 %  
• Zoom  
From 25 % to 400 % in 1 % steps  
Maximum number of continuous copy sets  
1 – 9999 copies  
Copy paper capacity:  
• Tray 1 (Tandem tray) : 2,000 sheets (1,000 sheets × 2) (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 2 (550-sheet tray) : 500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 3 (550-sheet tray) : 500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 4 (LCIT RT5000): 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 4 (LCIT RT5010): 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 5 (LCIT RT5000): 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 5 (LCIT RT5010): 2,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 6 (LCIT RT5000): 2,550 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 6 (LCIT RT5010): 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
• Tray 7: 500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb Bond)  
9
Power consumption (Type 1: 90 copies/minute model):  
Full system *1  
2290W  
Main machine only  
Warm-up  
Stand-by  
Copying  
Maximum  
2210W  
370W  
420W  
1680W  
2940W  
1830W  
3060W  
*1  
Main machine with the finisher, Booklet FInisher, A3 LCIT, Multi bypass tray  
(Tray 7), ADF, interposer and Z-folding Unit.  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix  
Power consumption (Type 2: 110 copies/minute model):  
Full system *1  
2250W  
Main machine only  
Warm-up  
Stand-by  
Copying  
Maximum  
2190W  
400W  
460W  
1890W  
2960W  
2110W  
3080W  
*1  
Main machine with the finisher, Booklet FInisher, A3 LCIT, Multi bypass tray  
(Tray 7), ADF, interposer and Z-folding Unit.  
Power consumption (Type 3: 135 copies/minute model):  
Full system *1  
2310W  
Main machine only  
Warm-up  
Stand-by  
Copying  
Maximum  
2240W  
430W  
480W  
2160W  
3730W  
2340W  
3850W  
*1  
Main machine with the finisher, Booklet FInisher, A3 LCIT, Multi bypass tray  
(Tray 7), ADF, interposer and Z-folding Unit.  
Dimensions (W × D × H up to exposure glass):  
870 × 858.5 × 1,000 mm, 34.23" × 33.78" × 39.34"  
Space for main machine (W × D):  
• 1,202 × 858.5 mm, 47.3" × 33.78" (ADF external extender is not used, option-  
al output tray is installed.)  
• 2,218 × 858.5 mm, 87.3" × 33.78" (ADF external extender is used for larger  
size originals, optional finisher proof tray is installed.)  
9
Noise emission *1 (Type 1):  
Sound power level  
Complete system *3  
less than 78 dB (A)  
less than 64 dB (A)  
Main machine only  
less than 74 dB (A)  
less than 60 dB (A)  
Copying  
Stand-by  
Sound pressure level *2  
Complete system *3  
Main machine only  
less than 68 dB (A)  
less than 54 dB (A)  
Copying  
Stand-by  
*1  
The above measurements are ISO 7779 actual values.  
Measured at the position of the bystander/operator. During printing.  
Main machine with full options.  
*2  
*3  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Specifications for the Main Unit  
Noise emission *1 (Type 2):  
Sound power level  
Complete system *3  
less than 80 dB (A)  
less than 70 dB (A)  
Main machine only  
Copying  
Stand-by  
less than 76 dB (A)  
less than 66 dB (A)  
Sound pressure level *2  
Complete system *3  
Main machine only  
less than 70 dB (A)  
less than 60 dB (A)  
Copying  
Stand-by  
*1  
The above measurements are ISO 7779 actual values.  
Measured at the position of the bystander/operator. During printing.  
Main machine with full options.  
*2  
*3  
Noise emission *1 (Type 3):  
Sound power level  
Complete system *3  
less than 83 dB (A)  
less than 78 dB (A)  
Main machine only  
Copying  
Stand-by  
less than 79 dB (A)  
less than 74 dB (A)  
Sound pressure level *2  
Complete system *3  
Main machine only  
less than 73 dB (A)  
less than 68 dB (A)  
Copying  
Stand-by  
*1  
The above measurements are ISO 7779 actual values.  
Measured at the position of the bystander/operator. During printing.  
Main machine with full options.  
*2  
*3  
9
Weight:  
Type 1, 2: Approx. 299kg, 659.2lb (main machine with the ADF)  
Type 3: Approx. 305kg, 672.4lb (main machine with the ADF)  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Appendix  
Document Server  
HDD:  
160 GB × 2  
HDD (Document Server):  
45 GB  
Capacity:  
• Copy: Approx. 3,000 sheets (ITUT-No.4 chart)  
• Batch mode: Approx. 3,000 sheets (ITUT-No.4 chart)  
• Printer: Approx. 15,000 sheets (600 dpi)  
• Scanner: Approx. 3,000 sheets (200 dpi/Text) (ITUT-No.4 chart) *1  
Note  
If you need to change the capacity of the document server, contact your  
service representative.  
Maximum number of stored documents:  
3,000  
Maximum pages of stored documents:  
15,000 sheets  
Maximum number of pages per document:  
2,000  
Capacity (Memory Sorting):  
6.75 GB (A4/81/2" × 11" : Approx. 333 sheets-3000 sheets at maximum) *2  
9
Capacity (Others):  
10.0 GB  
*1  
Scanning Condition: ITUT-No.4 chart/200 dpi/Text/A4/MMR  
*2  
The capacity will change when the multiple functions are used.  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Specifications for the Main Unit  
Auto Document Feeder  
Mode:  
ADF mode, Batch mode, SADF mode, Mixed Sizes mode, Thin mode  
Original size:  
• A3L–A5KL  
• 11" × 17"L– 81/2" × 51/2"KL  
Original weight:  
• 1-sided originals: 52 - 157 g/m2 (14 - 42 lb. Bond)  
• 2-sided originals: 52 - 128 g/m2 (14 - 34 lb. Bond) (Duplex)  
• Thin paper mode: 40 - 156 g/m2 (11 -42 lb. Bond)  
Number of originals that can be set:  
100 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond) of less than 12 mm, 0.5"  
Copying speed:  
80 copies/minute (A4K, 81/2" × 11"K, 1 to 1 copying)  
Power Source:  
Supplied from the main machine.  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
9
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix  
Specifications for Options  
Finisher SR5000  
Finisher Upper Tray:  
Paper size:  
A3L, B4L, A4KL, B5KL, A5KL, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L,  
81/2" × 11"KL, 51/2" × 81/2"KL, 12" × 18"L  
Paper weight:  
52 – 216 g/m2, 14 – 58 lb. Bond  
Stack capacity:  
• 500 sheets (A4KL, B5KL, A5KL, 81/2" × 11"KL, 51/2" × 81/2"KL)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 250 sheets (A3L, B4L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L, 12" × 18"L)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Finisher Shift Tray:  
Paper size:  
A3L, B4L, A4KL, B5KL, A5KL, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L,  
81/2" × 11"KL, 51/2" × 81/2"KL, 12" × 18"L  
Paper weight:  
52 – 300 g/m2, 14 – 80 lb. Bond  
Stack capacity:  
• 3,000 sheets (A4K, B5K, 81/2" × 11"K) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
9
• 1,500 sheets (A3L, B4L, A4L, B5L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L,  
81/2" × 11"L, 12" × 18"L) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 500 sheets (A5K, 51/2" × 81/2"K) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 100 sheets (A5L, 51/2" × 81/2"L) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Staple paper size:  
A3L, B4L, A4KL, B5KL, 11" × 17"L,81/2" × 14"L, 81/2" × 11"KL  
Staple paper weight:  
64 – 80 g/m2, 17 – 20 lb. Bond  
Staple capacity:  
• 100 sheets (A4KL, B5KL, 81/2" × 11"KL) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 50 sheets (A3L, B4L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Specifications for Options  
Stack capacity after stapling  
• 200–30 sets (10–100 sheets) (A4KL, B5KL, 81/2" × 11"KL)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 150 sets (2–9 sheets) (A4KL, B5KL, 81/2" × 11"KL)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 150–30 sets (10–50 sheets) (A3L, B4L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 150 sets (2–9 sheets) (A3L, B4L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L)  
(80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Staple position:  
4 position (Top, Top Slant, Bottom, 2 Staples)  
Power consumption:  
Approx. 120 W (supplied from the main machine)  
Dimensions (W × D × H):  
800 × 730 × 980 mm, 31.5" × 28.7" × 38.6"  
Weight:  
Approx. 75 kg, 163.3 lb.  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
Booklet Finisher BK5000  
To use the Booklet Finisher BK5000, the Finisher SR5000 is required.  
Saddle stitch paper size:  
A3L, B4L, A4L, B5L, 12" × 18"L, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L, 81/2" × 11"L  
9
Saddle stitch paper weight:  
64 – 90 g/m2, 17 – 28 lb. Bond  
Saddle stitch capacity:  
Max. 15 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Stack capacity after Saddle stitching  
• 30 sets (2–5 sheets) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 15 sets (6–10 sheets) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
• 10 sets (11–15 sheets) (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Saddle stitch position:  
center 2 position  
Power consumption:  
Approx. 100 W (power is supplied from the mainframe)  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
Dimensions (W × D × H):  
600 × 730 × 980 mm, 23.6” × 28.7” × 38.6” inch  
Weight:  
Approx. 70 kg, 152.4lb  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
Cover Interposer Tray CI5010  
To use the Cover Interposer Tray CI5010, the Finisher SR5000 or the Booklet Fin-  
isher BK5000 are required.  
Paper size:  
• Widrh: 13” – A5K / 51/2" × 81/2"K  
• Length: A5L / 51/2" × 81/2"L – 19”  
Paper weight:  
64 – 216 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond – 80 lb. Cover  
Paper capacity:  
200 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond) × 2  
Power consumption (Max):  
Approx. 95 W (supplied from the main machine)  
Dimensions (W × D × H):  
543 × 730 × 1270 mm, 21.3” × 28.7” × 50”  
Weight:  
9
Approx. 45 kg, 98.0 lb  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Specifications for Options  
Punch Unit PU5000  
To use the Punch Unit PU5000, the Finisher SR5000 or the Booklet Finisher  
BK5000 are required.  
Paper size:  
• 2 holes  
L: A3 - A6, 11" × 17" - 51/2" × 81/2"  
K: A4 - A5, 81/2" × 11", 51/2" × 81/2"  
• 3 holes  
L: A3, B4, 11" × 17"  
K: A4, B5, 81/2" × 11"  
• 4 holes (Europe)  
L: A3, B4, 11" × 17"  
K: A4, B5, 81/2" × 11"  
• 4 holes (North Europe)  
L: A3 - B6, 11" × 17" - 51/2" × 81/2"  
K: A4 - A5, 81/2" × 11", 51/2" × 81/2"  
Paper weight:  
52 – 163 g/m2, 14 lb. – 43 lb. Bond  
• 2 holes  
52 – 163 g/m2, 14 lb. – 43 lb. Bond  
• 3 holes  
52 – 163 g/m2, 14 lb. – 43 lb. Bond  
• 4 holes (Europe)  
52 – 128 g/m2, 14 lb. – 34 lb. Bond  
• 4 holes (North Europe)  
52 – 128 g/m2, 14 lb. – 34 lb. Bond  
9
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
Z-folding Unit ZF4000  
To use the Z-folding Unit ZF4000, the Booklet Finisher BK5000 is required.  
Paper size:  
A3L, B4JISL, A4KL, B5KL, 11" × 17"L, 81/2" × 14"L, 81/2" × 11"KL  
Paper weight:  
64 – 80 g/m2, 17 – 20 lb. Bond  
Power consumption  
Maximum. 100 W (a separate power source is required)  
Dimensions (W × D × H):  
177 × 620 × 960 mm, 6.9" × 24.4" × 37.8"  
Weight:  
Approx. 55 kg, 121.3 lb  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
LCIT RT5000  
A4 Large Capacity Tray  
Paper size:  
A4L, B5L, A5KL, 17" × 11"L, 81/2" × 51/2"KL  
Paper weight:  
Tray 4, 5: 52 – 216 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond – 80 lb. Cover, 110 lb Index  
9
Tray 6: 52 – 163 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond – 60 lb. Cover  
Paper capacity:  
Tray 4, 5: 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Tray 6: 2,550 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Total 4,550 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Power consumption  
Maximum. 135 W (supplied from the main machine)  
Dimensions (W × D × H, option unit):  
540 × 730 × 980 mm, 21.3" × 28.8" × 38.6"  
Weight:  
Approx. 87 kg (192 lb) or less  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Specifications for Options  
LCIT RT5010  
A3 Large Capacity Tray  
Paper size:  
Length: A5K / 81/2" × 51/2"K – 19”  
Width: A5L / 81/2" × 51/2"L – 13”, 100 mm width with the special side fence  
Paper weight:  
Tray 4 – Tray 6: 52 – 216 g/m2, 16 lb. Bond – 80 lb. Cover, 110 lb. Index  
Paper capacity:  
Tray 4, 6: 1,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Tray 5: 2,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Total 4,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Power consumption  
Maximum. 135 W (supplied from the main machine)  
Dimensions (W × D × H, option unit):  
880 × 730 × 980 mm, 21.3" × 28.8" × 38.6"  
Weight:  
Approx. 163 kg, 359.5lb  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
Multi Bypass Tray BY5000 (Tray 7)  
9
Paper size:  
Width: 100 mm – 13”  
Length: A5L / 81/2" × 51/2"L – 19”  
Paper weight:  
52 - 216 g /m2, 16 lb. Bond - 80 lb. Cover  
Paper capacity:  
500 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb. Bond)  
Power consumption:  
Maximum. 75 W (supplied from the main machine)  
Dimensions (W × D × H):  
702 × 556 × 202 mm, 27.6” × 21.9” × 8.0”  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Appendix  
Weight:  
Approx. 18 kg (39.7 lb) or less  
Note  
Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
Others  
A3 / 11" × 17" Tray Unit TK5000  
You can load A3L or 11" × 17"L paper in tray 1 using this unit.  
Copy Connector Type 3260  
You can utilize the connect copy function bridging two machines with the  
Copy Connector Type 3260.  
Copy Data Security Unit Type E  
The Copy Data Security Unit Type E deletes images and prints the gray  
ground color of the paper, when the documents marked unauthorized are  
copied.  
Data OverWriteSecurity Unit F  
The Data OverWriteSecurity Unit F overwrites the data that remains on the  
hard disk, automatically.  
9
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information about Installed Software  
Information about Installed Software  
expat  
• The software including controller, etc. (hereinafter "software") installed on  
this product uses the expat under the conditions mentioned below.  
• The product manufacturer provides warranty and support to the software of  
the product including the expat, and the product manufacturer makes the ini-  
tial developer and copyright holder of the expat, free from these obligations.  
• Information relating to the expat is available at:  
http://expat.sourceforge.net/  
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Centre, Ltd. and Clark  
Cooper.  
Copyright © 2001, 2002 Expat maintainers.  
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of  
this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the  
Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use,  
copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the  
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, sub-  
ject to the following conditions:  
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all  
copies or substantial portions of the Software.  
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY  
KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AU-  
THORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAG-  
ES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,  
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION  
WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFT-  
WARE.  
9
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
NetBSD  
1. Copyright Notice of NetBSD  
For all users to use this product:  
This product contains NetBSD operating system:  
For the most part, the software constituting the NetBSD operating system is not  
in the public domain; its authors retain their copyright.  
The following text shows the copyright notice used for many of the NetBSD  
source code. For exact copyright notice applicable for each of the files/binaries,  
the source code tree must be consulted.  
A full source code can be found at http://www.netbsd.org/.  
Copyright © 1999, 2000 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.  
All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
A Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
B Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation  
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
C All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must  
display the following acknowledgment:  
This product includes software developed by The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.  
and its contributors.  
D Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its contribu-  
tors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software  
without specific prior written permission.  
9
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND  
CONTRIBUTORS ''AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,  
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MER-  
CHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DIS-  
CLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS  
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEM-  
PLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMIT-  
ED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF  
USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER  
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CON-  
TRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTH-  
ERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,  
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information about Installed Software  
2.Authors Name List  
All product names mentioned herein are trademarks of their respective owners.  
The following notices are required to satisfy the license terms of the software  
that we have mentioned in this document:  
• This product includes software developed by the University of California,  
Berkeley and its contributors.  
• This product includes software developed by Jonathan R. Stone for the NetB-  
SD Project.  
• This product includes software developed by the NetBSD Foundation, Inc.  
and its contributors.  
• This product includes software developed by Manuel Bouyer.  
• This product includes software developed by Charles Hannum.  
• This product includes software developed by Charles M. Hannum.  
• This product includes software developed by Christopher G. Demetriou.  
• This product includes software developed by TooLs GmbH.  
• This product includes software developed by Terrence R. Lambert.  
• This product includes software developed by Adam Glass and Charles Han-  
num.  
• This product includes software developed by Theo de Raadt.  
• This product includes software developed by Jonathan Stone and Jason R.  
Thorpe for the NetBSD Project.  
• This product includes software developed by the University of California,  
Lawrence Berkeley Laboratory and its contributors.  
• This product includes software developed by Christos Zoulas.  
• This product includes software developed by Christopher G. Demetriou for  
the NetBSD Project.  
9
• This product includes software developed by Paul Kranenburg.  
• This product includes software developed by Adam Glass.  
• This product includes software developed by Jonathan Stone.  
• This product includes software developed by Jonathan Stone for the NetBSD  
Project.  
• This product includes software developed by Winning Strategies, Inc.  
• This product includes software developed by Frank van der Linden for the  
NetBSD Project.  
• This product includes software developed for the NetBSD Project by Frank  
van der Linden  
• This product includes software developed for the NetBSD Project by Jason R.  
Thorpe.  
• The software was developed by the University of California, Berkeley.  
• This product includes software developed by Chris Provenzano, the Univer-  
sity of California, Berkeley, and contributors.  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Sablotron  
Sablotron (Version 0.82) Copyright © 2000 Ginger Alliance Ltd. All Rights Re-  
served  
a) The application software installed on this product includes the Sablotron soft-  
ware Version 0.82 (hereinafter, "Sablotron 0.82"), with modifications made by  
the product manufacturer. The original code of the Sablotron 0.82 is provided by  
Ginger Alliance Ltd., the initial developer, and the modified code of the Sa-  
blotron 0.82 has been derived from such original code provided by Ginger Alli-  
ance Ltd.  
b) The product manufacturer provides warranty and support to the application  
software of this product including the Sablotron 0.82 as modified, and the prod-  
uct manufacturer makes Ginger Alliance Ltd., the initial developer of the Sa-  
blotron 0.82, free from these obligations.  
c) The Sablotron 0.82 and the modifications thereof are made available under the  
terms of Mozilla Public License Version 1.1 (hereinafter, "MPL 1.1"), and the ap-  
plication software of this product constitutes the "Larger Work" as defined in  
MPL 1.1. The application software of this product except for the Sablotron 0.82  
as modified is licensed by the product manufacturer under separate agree-  
ment(s).  
d) The source code of the modified code of the Sablotron 0.82 is available at: ht-  
tp://support-download.com/services/device/sablot/notice082.html  
e) The source code of the Sablotron software is available at: http://www.ginger-  
all.com  
f) MPL 1.1 is available at: http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/MPL-1.1.html  
JPEG LIBRARY  
9
• The software installed on this product is based in part on the work of the In-  
dependent JPEG Group.  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Information about Installed Software  
SASL  
CMU libsasl  
Tim Martin  
Rob Earhart  
Rob Siemborski  
Copyright (c) 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
A Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
B Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation  
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
C The name "Carnegie Mellon University" must not be used to endorse or pro-  
mote products derived from this software without prior written permission.  
For permission or any other legal details, please contact:  
Office of Technology Transfer  
Carnegie Mellon University  
5000 Forbes Avenue  
Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890  
(412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395  
D Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowl-  
edgment:  
"This product includes software developed by Computing Services at Carn-  
egie Mellon University (http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."  
9
CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH  
REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES  
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE  
MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CON-  
SEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING  
FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF  
CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT  
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS  
SOFTWARE.  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix  
MD4  
Copyright (C) 1990-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. All rights reserved.  
License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it is identified as  
the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material  
mentioning or referencing this software or this function.  
License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided that such  
works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data Security, Inc. MD4 Message-  
Digest Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing the derived work.  
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either the mer-  
chantability of this software or the suitability of this software for any particular  
purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty of any kind.  
These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this documentation  
and/or software.  
MD5  
Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All rights reserved.  
License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it is identified as  
the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material  
mentioning or referencing this software or this function.  
9
License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided that such  
works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5 Message-  
Digest Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing the derived work.  
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either the mer-  
chantability of this software or the suitability of this software for any particular  
purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty of any kind.  
These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this documentation  
and/or software.  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Information about Installed Software  
Samba(Ver 3.0.4)  
For SMB transmission, this machine uses Samba ver 3.0.4 (hereinafter referred to  
as Samba 3.0.4).  
Copyright © Andrew Tridgell 1994-1998  
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the  
terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software  
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.  
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT  
ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILI-  
TY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public  
License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,  
Inc., 675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA.  
Note  
The source code for SMB transmission by this machine can be downloaded  
from the following website:  
http://support-download.com/services/scbs  
RSA BSAFE®  
• This product includes RSA BSAFE® cryptographic or security protocol soft-  
ware from RSA Security Inc.  
9
• RSA and BSAFE are registered trademarks of RSA Security Inc. in the United  
States and/or other countries.  
• RSA Security Inc. All rights reserved.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix  
Open SSL  
Copyright (c) 1998-2004 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or  
other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must dis-  
play the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software devel-  
oped by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit.  
(http://www.openssl.org/)"  
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to en-  
dorse or promote products derived from this software without prior written per-  
mission. For written permission, please contact [email protected].  
5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may  
"OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written permission of the  
OpenSSL Project.  
9
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowl-  
edgment: "This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for  
use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)"  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND  
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIM-  
ITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FIT-  
NESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT  
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CON-  
SEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCURE-  
MENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR  
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILI-  
TY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN  
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF  
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information about Installed Software  
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young  
([email protected]). This product includes software written by Tim Hudson  
Original SSLeay License  
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]) All rights reserved.  
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young (eay@crypt-  
soft.com).  
The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.  
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the follow-  
ing conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply to all code found  
in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL  
code. The SSL documentation included with this distribution is covered by the  
same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).  
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code  
are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be  
given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the  
form of a textual message at program startup or in documentation (online or tex-  
tual) provided with the package.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
9
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of con-  
ditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or  
other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must dis-  
play the following acknowledgement: "This product includes cryptographic  
software written by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word 'cryptographic'  
can be left out if the rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic  
related :-).  
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the  
apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement: "This  
product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected])"  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND ANY EX-  
PRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR  
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE  
AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,  
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES  
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE  
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS IN-  
TERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,  
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING  
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE  
OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH  
DAMAGE.  
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or deriv-  
ative of this code cannot be changed. i.e this code cannot simply be copied and  
put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]  
Open SSH  
The licences which components of this software fall under are as follows. First,  
we will summarize and say that all components are under a BSD licence, or a li-  
cence more free than that.  
OpenSSH contains no GPL code.  
1)  
Copyright (c) 1995 Tatu Ylonen <[email protected]>, Espoo, Finland All rights re-  
served  
9
As far as I am concerned, the code I have written for this software can be used  
freely for any purpose. Any derived versions of this software must be clearly  
marked as such, and if the derived work is incompatible with the protocol de-  
scription in the RFC file, it must be called by a name other than "ssh" or "Secure  
Shell".  
[Tatu continues]  
However, I am not implying to give any licenses to any patents or copyrights  
held by third parties, and the software includes parts that are not under my di-  
rect control. As far as I know, all included source code is used in accordance with  
the relevant license agreements and can be used freely for any purpose (the  
GNU license being the most restrictive); see below for details.  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information about Installed Software  
[However, none of that term is relevant at this point in time. All of these restric-  
tively licenced software components which he talks about have been removed  
from OpenSSH, i.e.,  
- RSA is no longer included, found in the OpenSSL library  
- IDEA is no longer included, its use is deprecated  
- DES is now external, in the OpenSSL library  
- GMP is no longer used, and instead we call BN code from OpenSSL  
- Zlib is now external, in a library  
- The make-ssh-known-hosts script is no longer included  
- TSS has been removed  
- MD5 is now external, in the OpenSSL library  
- RC4 support has been replaced with ARC4 support from OpenSSL  
- Blowfish is now external, in the OpenSSL library  
[The licence continues]  
Note that any information and cryptographic algorithms used in this software  
are publicly available on the Internet and at any major bookstore, scientific li-  
brary, and patent office worldwide. More information can be found e.g. at "ht-  
tp://www.cs.hut.fi/crypto".  
The legal status of this program is some combination of all these permissions  
and restrictions. Use only at your own responsibility. You will be responsible for  
any legal consequences yourself; I am not making any claims whether possess-  
ing or using this is legal or not in your country, and I am not taking any respon-  
sibility on your behalf.  
9
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
NO WARRANTY  
BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO  
WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLI-  
CABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE  
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PRO-  
GRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED  
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WAR-  
RANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE  
OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DE-  
FECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, RE-  
PAIR OR CORRECTION.  
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO  
IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY  
WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMIT-  
TED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GEN-  
ERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING  
OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCU-  
RATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE  
OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN  
IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSI-  
BILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.  
2)  
The 32-bit CRC compensation attack detector in deattack.c was contributed by  
CORE SDI S.A. under a BSD-style license.  
9
Cryptographic attack detector for ssh - source code  
Copyright (c) 1998 CORE SDI S.A., Buenos Aires, Argentina.  
All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or  
without modification, are permitted provided that this copyright notice is re-  
tained.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL CORE SDI S.A. BE  
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLA-  
RY OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES RESULTING FROM THE USE OR MIS-  
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE.  
Ariel Futoransky <[email protected]>  
<http://www.core-sdi.com>  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information about Installed Software  
3)  
One component of the ssh source code is under a 3-clause BSD license, held by  
the University of California, since we pulled these parts from original Berkeley  
code.  
Copyright (c) 1983, 1990, 1992, 1993, 1995  
The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or  
other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be  
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specif-  
ic prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS  
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY  
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSE-  
QUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCURE-  
MENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR  
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILI-  
TY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN  
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF  
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
9
4)  
Remaining components of the software are provided under a standard 2-term  
BSD licence with the following names as copyright holders:  
Markus Friedl  
Theo de Raadt  
Niels Provos  
Dug Song  
Kevin Steves  
Daniel Kouril  
Wesley Griffin  
Per Allansson  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Jason Downs  
Solar Designer  
Todd C. Miller  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or  
other materials provided with the distribution.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EX-  
PRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR  
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE  
AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPE-  
CIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;  
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOW-  
EVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CON-  
TRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR  
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFT-  
WARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
5)  
Portable OpenSSH contains the following additional licenses:  
c) Compatibility code (openbsd-compat)  
Apart from the previously mentioned licenses, various pieces of code in the  
openbsd-compat/ subdirectory are licensed as follows:  
9
Some code is licensed under a 3-term BSD license, to the following copyright  
holders:  
Todd C. Miller  
Theo de Raadt  
Damien Miller  
Eric P. Allman  
The Regents of the University of California  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modifica-  
tion, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information about Installed Software  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list  
of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or  
other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be  
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specif-  
ic prior written permission.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS  
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY  
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO  
EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY  
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSE-  
QUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCURE-  
MENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR  
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON  
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILI-  
TY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN  
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF  
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
Open LDAP  
The OpenLDAP Public License Version 2.8, 17 August 2003  
Redistribution and use of this software and associated documentation ("Soft-  
ware"), with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following  
conditions are met:  
9
1. Redistributions in source form must retain copyright statements and notices,  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce applicable copyright state-  
ments and notices, this list of conditions, and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution, and  
3. Redistributions must contain a verbatim copy of this document.  
The OpenLDAP Foundation may revise this license from time to time. Each revi-  
sion is distinguished by a version number. You may use this Software under terms  
of this license revision or under the terms of any subsequent revision of the license.  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION AND  
ITS CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRAN-  
TIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE  
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OPENLDAP FOUNDATION, ITS  
CONTRIBUTORS, OR THE AUTHOR(S) OR OWNER(S) OF THE SOFTWARE  
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEM-  
PLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED  
TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,  
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED  
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT  
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARIS-  
ING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED  
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
The names of the authors and copyright holders must not be used in advertising  
or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealing in this Software without  
specific, written prior permission. Title to copyright in this Software shall at all  
times remain with copyright holders.  
OpenLDAP is a registered trademark of the OpenLDAP Foundation.  
Copyright 1999-2003 The OpenLDAP Foundation, Redwood City, California,  
USA. All Rights Reserved. Permission to copy and distribute verbatim copies of  
this document is granted.  
9
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Changing a Registered Name, 185  
Changing the Display Language, 235  
Changing the registered SMB Folder  
Destination, 204  
Changing Tray Paper Settings, 89  
Channel, 59  
Checking the Connection, 13  
Clearing the Counter, 194  
Clearing the Number of Prints, 194  
Communication Mode, 59  
Compression, 177  
A
About Address Book, 179  
Accessing User Tools (System Settings), 3  
A.C.S. Sensitivity Level, 175  
Address Book  
Change Order, 68  
Edit Title, 68  
Program/Change/Delete Group, 68  
Select Title, 68  
Address Book Management, 68  
ADF Original Table Elevation, 43  
Adjustment Settings for Operators, 241  
Administrator Authentication  
Management, 68  
Administrator's E-mail Address, 62  
Administrator Tools / System Settings, 68  
AOF (Always On), 68  
Append CR to LF, 168  
Authentication Information, 187, 231  
Auto Continue, 162  
Auto Delete File in Document Server, 68  
Auto Delete Stored Print Jobs, 162  
Auto Delete Temporary Print, 162  
Auto Image Density Priority, 113  
Auto Logout Timer, 49  
Configuration Page, 157  
Connecting to the Ethernet Interface, 8  
Connecting to the IEEE 1284 Interface, 11  
Connecting to the IEEE 1394 Interface, 10  
Connecting to the IEEE 802.11b (Wireless  
LAN) Interface, 12  
Connecting with the USB Interface, 9  
Copier/Document Server Auto Reset  
Timer, 49  
Copier/Document Server Features / Edit, 124  
General Features, 113  
Input/Output, 142  
Auto Off Timer, 49  
Auto Specify Sender Name, 62  
Auto Tray Switching, 113  
Copier/Document Server Features on  
Main and Sub-machines, 146  
B
Copier/Document Server Features /  
Stamp, 130  
Copies, 162  
Copy Back Cover, 124  
Copy Count Display, 43  
Copy Eject Face Method in Glass Mode, 142  
Copy on Designating Page in Combine, 124  
Copy Orientation in Duplex Mode, 113  
Counter, 238  
Background Density of ADS (Full Color), 175  
Background Numbering, 130  
Back Margin  
Left/Right, 124  
Top / Bottom, 124  
Back Up / Restore Address Book, 68  
Bidirectional Communication, 56  
Bidirectional SCSI print, 57  
Blank Page Print, 162  
Booklet Finisher BK5000, 261  
Bypass Tray Setting Priority, 162  
Courier Font, 168  
Cover Interposer Tray CI5000, 262  
Creep Setting for Magazine, 124  
Customized Function  
C
Document Server Storage, 113  
Capture Server IP Address, 62  
Change Original Counter Display, 113  
Change PDF Password, 171  
Copier, 113  
Changing a FTP Folder Destination, 209  
Changing a Group Name, 226  
Changing an E-mail Destination, 198  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Erase Center Width, 124  
Erase Original Shadow in Combine, 124  
Error Log, 157  
Ethernet Speed, 52  
Extend A4 Width, 168  
Extended Security, 68  
D
Dark Background, 113  
Data Format, 170  
Date Stamp, 135  
DDNS Configuration, 52  
DDNS Configuration (IEEE 1394), 57  
Default Printer Language, 162  
Default User Name/Password (Send), 62  
Delete All Files in Document Server, 68  
Delete All Stored Print Jobs, 161  
Delete All Temporary Print Jobs, 161  
Delete Scanner Journal, 173  
Deleting a FTP Folder Destination, 211  
Deleting a Goup, 227  
Deleting a Group Within Another Group, 224  
Deleting a NCP Folder Destination, 217  
Deleting an E-mail Destination, 199  
Deleting a Registered Name, 186  
Deleting a User Code, 190  
File Transfer / System Settingse, 62  
Finisher  
Punch Type, 142  
Stapling Position, 142  
Finisher SR5000, 260  
Firmware Version, 68  
Folder Destination, 200  
Font (Date Stamp), 135  
Font Number, 168  
Font (Page Numbering), 137  
Font Pitch, 168  
Font Source, 168  
Font (Stamp Text), 140  
Format (Date Stamp), 135  
Form Lines, 168  
Front Margin  
Delivery Option, 62  
Density (Background Numbering), 130  
Destination List Display Priority 1, 173  
Destination List Display Priority 2, 173  
Display, 2  
Display / Clear / Print Counter per User, 68  
Displaying Names Registered in a Group, 222  
Displaying the Counter for Each User, 191  
Display of concatenated copy key, 113  
Display / Print Counter, 68  
Divide. Send E-mail, 177  
Left/Right, 124  
Top/Bottom, 124  
Function Priority, 43  
Function Reset Timer, 43  
DNS Configuration, 52  
Document Server, 145  
Domain Name, 52  
Domain Name (IEEE 1394), 57  
Double Copies Position, 124  
Double Copies Separation Line, 124  
Duplex, 162  
General Features / Copier/Document  
Server Features, 113  
General Settings / Scanner Features, 173  
General Settings / System Settings, 43  
Generation Copy, 113  
Duplex Back Page Stamping Position  
(Page Numbering), 137  
H
Hex Dump, 157  
E
High Compression PDF Level, 177  
Host Interface / Printer Features, 167  
Host Name, 52  
Edge to Edge Print, 162  
Edit / Copier/Document Server Features, 124  
Effective Protocol, 52  
Host Name (IEEE 1394), 57  
E-mail Communication Port, 62  
E-mail Destination, 196  
E-mail Information Language, 177  
E-mail Reception Interval, 62  
E-mail Storage in Server, 62  
Energy Saver Timer, 49  
IEEE 1394, 57  
IEEE 802.11b, 14, 59  
Image Repeat Separation Line, 124  
Input/Output / Copier/Document  
Server Features, 142  
Enhanced Authentication Management, 68  
Erase Border Width, 124  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input Prime, 56  
Inquiry, 236  
Network, 52  
Network Security Level, 68  
Network Settings, 15  
No. of Digits for Single Page Files, 177  
Number of Scanner Resends, 62  
NW Frame Type, 52  
Insert Separation Sheet, 142  
Interface Settings / System Settings, 52  
Interleave Print, 43  
Interpreting the configuration page, 159  
I/O Buffer, 167  
I/O Timeout, 167  
IPv4 Address (IEEE 1394), 57  
IPv4 Gateway Address, 52  
IPv4 over 1394, 57  
IPv6 Gateway Address, 52  
IPv6 Stateless Address  
Autoconfiguration, 52  
Items of Tray Paper Settings, 91  
Orientation, 168  
Booklet, Magazine, 124  
Original counter reset key, 113  
Original Orientation in Duplex Mode, 113  
Original Type Display, 113  
J
Copier, 43  
Document Server, 43  
Printer, 43  
Output tray settings, 48  
Job End Call, 113  
Job Separation, 162  
K
Key Counter Management, 68  
Key Repeat, 43  
Page Numbering, 137  
Page Numbering in Combine (Page  
Numbering), 137  
Page Numbering Initial Letter (Page  
Numbering), 137  
Page Size, 162  
Pale, 113  
Panel Features Default, 113  
Panel Key Sound, 43  
Panel Off Timer, 49  
L
LAN Type, 52  
LCIT RT5000, 264  
LCIT RT5010, 265  
LDAP Authentication, 233  
LDAP Search, 68  
Letterhead Setting, 162  
List / Test Print Lock, 161  
Paper Display, 113  
Paper Tray Priority  
M
Copier, 43  
Printer, 43  
Parallel Communication Speed, 56  
Parallel Interface, 56  
Machine IPv4 Address, 52  
Machine IPv6 Address, 52  
Machine Name, 52  
Maintenance / Printer Features, 161  
Max. Copy Quantity, 113  
Max. E-mail Size, 177  
Max. Reception E-mail Size, 62  
Memory Full Auto Scan Restart, 142  
Memory Overflow, 162  
Memory Usage, 162  
Menu List, 157  
Multi Bypass Tray BY5000 (Tray 7), 265  
Multiple Lists, 157  
Parallel Timing, 56  
PCL Menu / Printer Features, 168  
PDF Configuration/Font Page, 157  
PDF Group Password, 171  
PDF Menu / Printer Features, 171  
Permit SNMPv3 Communication, 52  
Permit SSL/TLS Communication, 52  
Photo, 113  
Ping Command, 52  
Point Size, 168  
POP3/IMAP4 Settings, 62  
POP before SMTP, 62  
Preset Stamp, 130  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print Address Book  
Destination List, 68  
Registering user names and destination  
names, 184  
Reproduction Ratio / Copier/Document  
Server Features, 120  
R/E Ratio, 120  
R/E Ratio Priority, 120  
Reservation Screen Auto-off Timer, 113  
Reserved Job Waiting Time, 162  
Reserve Job Mode, 113  
Resolution, 168, 170, 171  
Restore Factory Defaults, 59  
Print & Delete Scanner Journal, 173  
Printer Auto Reset Timer, 49  
Printer Features / Host Interface, 167  
Printer Features / Maintenance, 161  
Printer Features / PCL Menu, 168  
Printer Features / PDF Menu, 171  
Printer Features / PS Menu, 170  
Printer Features / System, 162  
Printer Features / Test Print, 157  
Printer Language, 162  
Print Error Report, 162  
Printing the configuration page, 158  
Printing the Counter for All User, 193  
Printing the Counter for Each User, 192  
Print List, 60  
SADF Auto Reset, 142  
Scanner Auto Reset Timer, 49  
Scanner Features / General Settings, 173  
Scanner Features / Scan Settings, 175  
Scanner Features / Send Settings, 177  
Scanner Resend Interval Time, 62  
Scan Settings / Scanner Features, 175  
Screen Color Setting, 43  
SCSI print (SBP-2), 57  
Security Method, 59  
Selection Signal Status, 56  
Print Priority, 43  
Print Scanner Journal, 173  
Program/Change Administrator, 68  
Message, 62  
Program / Change / Delete LDAP  
Server, 68, 77  
Program/Change/Delete User Text, 43  
Program/Delete Stamp (User Stamp), 133  
Programming the LDAP server, 78  
PS Configuration/Font Page, 157  
PS Menu / Printer Features, 170  
Punch Unit PU5000, 263  
Send Settings / Scanner Features, 177  
Separation Line in Combine, 124  
Set Date, 49  
Set Time, 49  
Q
Settings for the Document Server, 145  
Settings Required to Use Document  
Server, 31  
Settings Required to Use Document  
Server / Ethernet, 31  
Settings Required to Use Document  
Server / IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394), 32  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN), 32  
Settings Required to Use E-mail Function  
/ Ethernet, 18  
Settings Required to Use E-mail Function  
/ IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394), 19  
Settings Required to Use E-mail Function  
/ IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN), 20  
Settings Required to Use Network  
Quitting Tray Paper Settings, 90  
R
Ratio for Create Margin, 120  
Reception Protocol, 62  
Registering a FTP Folder Destination, 207  
Registering a Group, 218  
Registering a NCP Folder Destination, 212  
Registering an SMB Folder Destination, 200  
User, 230  
Registering a Protection Code to a Single  
User, 228  
Registering a User Code, 187  
Registering Folders, 200  
Registering LDAP Authentication, 231, 233  
Registering Names, 184  
Registering Names to a Group, 219  
Registering SMTP Authentication, 231  
Settings Required to Use Network  
Settings Required to Use Network  
TWAIN Scanner / IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over  
1394), 29  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Settings Required to Use Network  
TWAIN Scanner / IEEE 802.11b  
(wireless LAN), 30  
Stamp Language (Preset Stamp), 130  
Stamp on Designating Slip Sheet (Page  
Numbering), 137  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder  
Function, 22  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder  
Function / Ethernet, 22  
Stamp Position (Page Numbering), 137  
Stamp Setting (Date Stamp), 135  
Stamp Setting (Stamp Text), 140  
Stamp Text, 140  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder  
Function / IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394), 23  
Settings Required to Use Scan to Folder  
Function / IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN), 24  
Settings Required to Use the Network  
Delivery Scanner, 25  
Settings Required to Use the Network  
Delivery Scanner / Ethernet, 25  
Settings Required to Use the Network  
Delivery Scanner / IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over  
1394), 26  
Settings Required to Use the Network  
Delivery Scanner / IEEE 802.11b  
(wireless LAN), 27  
Settings Required to Use the Printer, 15  
Settings Required to Use the Printer/  
Ethernet, 15  
Settings Required to Use the Printer/  
IEEE 1394 (IPv4 over 1394), 16  
Settings Required to Use the Printer/  
IEEE 802.11b (wireless LAN), 17  
Setup IEEE 802.11b, 12  
Setup Wireless LAN, 12  
Shortcut R/E, 120  
Stapling Position, 142  
Status Indicator, 43  
Stored File E-mail Method, 177  
Sub Paper Size, 162  
Superimpose (Date Stamp), 135  
Superimpose (Page Numbering), 137  
Superimpose (Stamp Text), 140  
Switch Title of Quick Dial Table, 173  
Symbol Set, 168  
System Auto Reset Timer, 49  
System / Printer Features, 162  
System Settings / Administrator Tools, 68  
System Settings / File Transfer, 62  
System Settings / General Features, 43  
System Settings on Main and Sub-  
machines, 83  
System Settings / Timer Settings, 49  
System Status/Job List Display Time, 43  
Test Print / Printer Features, 157  
Text, 113  
Text/photo, 113  
Time Interval between Printing Jobs, 43  
Signal Control, 56  
Simplified Screen  
Finishing Types, 142  
Size (Background Numbering), 130  
Size (Date Stamp), 135  
Size (Page Numbering), 137  
Size (Stamp Text), 140  
SMB Computer Name, 52  
SMB Work Group, 52  
SMTP Authentication, 62, 231  
SMTP Server, 62  
Original Remains, 113  
Toner Saving, 162  
Transfer Log Setting, 68  
Transmission Speed, 59  
Tray 1, 91  
Tray 2 - 3, 91  
Tray 4, 91  
Tray 5, 91  
Sort/Stack Shift setting, 142  
Special Original Display, 113  
Special Original Display Defaults, 113  
Specifications, 253  
Tray 6, 91  
Tray 7, 91  
Tray Paper Setting on Main and Sub-  
machines, 111  
Specifications for the Main Unit, 253  
SSID Setting, 59  
Features, 130  
Tray Paper Settings, 89  
Tray Switching, 162  
TWAIN Standby Time, 173  
Stamp Format  
1-5 (User Stamp), 133  
Stamp Format (Page Numbering), 137  
Stamp Format (Preset Stamp), 130  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
U
Update Delivery Server Destination List, 173  
User Authentication Management, 68  
User Code, 187  
User Stamp, 133  
Using SMB to Connect, 200  
Using Utilities to Make Settings, 33  
W
Wait Time for Next Orig.  
Exposure Glass, 175  
Wait Time for Next Original(s)  
SADF, 175  
Warm Up Beeper, 43  
Weekly Timer  
Monday-Sunday, 49  
Weekly Timer Code, 49  
WINS Configuration, 52  
WINS Configuration (IEEE 1394), 57  
Wireless LAN Signal, 59  
Z
Z-folding Unit ZF4000, 264  
Z-fold position, 43  
288  
EN  
USA  
D102-7572  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In accordance with IEC 60417, this machine uses the following symbols for the main power switch:  
a means POWER ON.  
c means STAND BY.  
Trademarks  
Microsoft®, Windows® and Windows NT® are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the  
United States and/or other countries.  
Acrobat® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated.  
NetWare is a registered trademark of Novell, Inc.  
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and might be trademarks of their  
respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights to those marks.  
The proper names of the Windows operating systems are as follows:  
The product name of Windows® 95 is Microsoft® Windows® 95  
The product name of Windows® 98 is Microsoft® Windows® 98  
The product name of Windows® Me is Microsoft® Windows® Millennium Edition (Windows Me)  
The product names of Windows® 2000 are as follows:  
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Advanced Server  
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Server  
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Professional  
The product names of Windows® XP are as follows:  
Microsoft® Windows® XP Professional  
Microsoft® Windows® XP Home Edition  
The product names of Windows ServerTM 2003 are as follows:  
Microsoft® Windows ServerTM 2003 Standard Edition  
Microsoft® Windows ServerTM 2003 Enterprise Edition  
Microsoft® Windows ServerTM 2003 Web Edition  
The product names of Windows® NT are as follows:  
Microsoft® Windows NT® Server 4.0  
Microsoft® Windows NT® Workstation 4.0  
Copyright © 2008  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Type for Pro 906EX  
Type for Pro 1106EX  
Type for Pro 1356EX  
EN USA D102-7572  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Land Pride Chipper WC1503 User Manual
Lenovo Computer Hardware 6393 User Manual
Life Fitness GPS Receiver TR9100 User Manual
Lindy Home Theater Server Personal Server User Manual
Magic Chef Electric Steamer MCSFS12ST User Manual
Magnadyne Portable DVD Player MV855 User Manual
Manley Labs Stereo Amplifier 75 150 SE PP 807 MONOBLOCK User Manual
Mark Levinson Stereo Amplifier N 320S User Manual
McCulloch Chainsaw 41BY66AR077 User Manual
MGE UPS Systems Power Supply 1100 User Manual